blob: 3e49d0e9835671a0ca061c2137890edb272da0ea [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6c1b6672019-02-26 16:43:49 +01007 2019/02/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
961 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100962 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
963 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200964
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200965nbthread <number>
966 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100967 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
968 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
969 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
970 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
971 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100972 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
973 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
974 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
975 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
976 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
977 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
978 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200979
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100981 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200982 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
983 starting the process. See also "daemon".
984
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100985presetenv <name> <value>
986 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
987 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
988 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
989 and "unsetenv".
990
991resetenv [<name> ...]
992 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
993 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
994 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
995 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
996 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
997 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
998 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
999 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1000
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001001stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001002 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1003 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1004 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1005 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1006 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1007 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001008 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001009 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1010 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1011 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1012 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001013
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001014server-state-base <directory>
1015 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001016 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1017 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001018
1019server-state-file <file>
1020 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1021 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1022 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1023 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1024 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1025 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1026 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1027 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001028 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1029 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001030
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001031setenv <name> <value>
1032 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1033 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1034 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1035 and "unsetenv".
1036
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001037ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1039 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001040 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001041 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001042 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1043 information and recommendations see e.g.
1044 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1045 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1046 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1047 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001048
1049ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1051 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1052 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1053 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1054 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001055 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1056 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1057 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001058 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001060ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1062 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1063 keyword to see available options.
1064
1065 Example:
1066 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001067 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001068
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001069ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1071 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001072 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001073 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001074 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1075 information and recommendations see e.g.
1076 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1077 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1078 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1079 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1080 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001081
1082ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1084 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1085 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1086 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1087 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001088 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1089 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1090 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1091 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001092
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001093ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1095 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1096 keyword to see available options.
1097
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001098ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1100 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1101 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001102 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001103 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001104 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1105 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1106 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1107 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001108 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1109 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1110 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1111
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001112ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1113 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1114 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1115 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1116
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001117stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1118 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1119 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1120 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001121 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001122 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001123
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001124 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1125 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1126 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001127
1128stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1129 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1130 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001131 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001132
1133stats maxconn <connections>
1134 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1135 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137uid <number>
1138 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1139 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1140 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1141 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1142
1143ulimit-n <number>
1144 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1145 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1146 option.
1147
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001148unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1149 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1150
1151 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1152 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1153 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1154 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1155 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1156 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1157 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1158 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1159 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1160 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1161
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001162unsetenv [<name> ...]
1163 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1164 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1165 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1166 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1167 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1168 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1169 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1170
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171user <user name>
1172 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1173 See also "uid" and "group".
1174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001175node <name>
1176 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1177
1178 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1179 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1180 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1181 traffic.
1182
1183description <text>
1184 Add a text that describes the instance.
1185
1186 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1187 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1188 "<" and ">" characters.
1189
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100119051degrees-data-file <file path>
1191 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001192 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000119751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001198 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1199 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1200 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1201
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200120551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001206 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1207 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1208
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1210 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1211
121251degrees-cache-size <number>
1213 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1214 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1215 By default, this cache is disabled.
1216
1217 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001218 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1219
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001220wurfl-data-file <file path>
1221 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1222 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1223
1224 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1225 with USE_WURFL=1.
1226
1227wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1228 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1229 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1230 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1231
1232 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1233
1234 Valid WURFL properties are:
1235 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1236
1237 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1238 device.
1239
1240 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1241 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1242
1243 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1244 particular web request.
1245
1246 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1247 used Libwurfl API version.
1248
1249 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1250 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1251 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1252
1253 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1254 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1255
1256 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1257 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1258
1259 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1260
1261 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1262
1263 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1264 with USE_WURFL=1.
1265
1266wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1267 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1268 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1269
1270 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1271 with USE_WURFL=1.
1272
1273wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1274 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1275 thus before the chroot.
1276
1277 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1278 with USE_WURFL=1.
1279
1280wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1281 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1282 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001283 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001284 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001285 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001286 mode is enabled by default.
1287
1288 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1289 with USE_WURFL=1.
1290
1291wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1292 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1293 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1294 - "0" : no cache is used.
1295 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1296 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1297 the highest performing option.
1298
1299 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1300 with USE_WURFL=1.
1301
1302wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1303 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1304 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1305
1306 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1307 with USE_WURFL=1.
1308
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001311-----------------------
1312
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001313busy-polling
1314 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1315 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1316 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1317 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1318 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1319 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1320 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1321 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1322 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1323 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1324 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1325 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1326 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1327 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1328 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1329 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1330 "poll" pollers.
1331
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001332max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1333 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1334 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1335 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1336 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1337 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1338 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1339 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1340 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342maxconn <number>
1343 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1344 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1345 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001346 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1347 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1348 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1349 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001350 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1351 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1352 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1353 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1354 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001356maxconnrate <number>
1357 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1358 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1359 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1360 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1361 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1362 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1363 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1364 fairness.
1365
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001366maxcomprate <number>
1367 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001368 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001369 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1370 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1371 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001372 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001373 default value.
1374
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001375maxcompcpuusage <number>
1376 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1377 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1378 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1379 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1380 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1381 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1382 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1383 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1384
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001385maxpipes <number>
1386 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1387 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1388 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1389 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1390 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1391 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1392
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001393maxsessrate <number>
1394 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1395 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1396 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1397 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1398 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1399 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1400 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1401 fairness.
1402
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001403maxsslconn <number>
1404 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1405 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1406 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1407 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1408 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1409 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1410 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001411 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1412 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1413 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1414 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1415 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1416 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1417 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001418
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001419maxsslrate <number>
1420 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1421 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1422 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1423 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1424 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1425 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1426 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1427 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1428 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1429 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1430
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001431maxzlibmem <number>
1432 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1433 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1434 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001435 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1436 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1437 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1438
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439noepoll
1440 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1441 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001442 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001443
1444nokqueue
1445 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1446 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1447 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1448
1449nopoll
1450 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1451 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001452 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001453 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001454
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001455nosplice
1456 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001457 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001458 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001459 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001460 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1461 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1462 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1463 "option splice-response".
1464
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001465nogetaddrinfo
1466 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1467 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1468
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001469noreuseport
1470 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1471 command line argument "-dR".
1472
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001473profiling.tasks { on | off }
1474 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1475 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1476 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1477 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1478 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1479 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1480 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1481 CLI.
1482
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001483spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001484 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1485 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1486 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1487 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1488 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1489 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001490
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001491ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001492 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001494 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1495 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1496 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1497 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1498 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001499 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1500 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001501 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1502 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1503 openssl configuration file uses:
1504 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1505
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001506ssl-mode-async
1507 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001508 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001509 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1510 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1511 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1512 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1513 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001514
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001515tune.buffers.limit <number>
1516 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1517 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1518 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1519 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1520 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001521 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001522 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1523 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1524 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1525 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1526 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1527 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1528 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1529 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1530 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1531
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001532tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1533 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1534 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1535 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1536 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1537
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001538tune.bufsize <number>
1539 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1540 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1541 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1542 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1543 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1544 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1545 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001546 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1547 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1548 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001549 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001550 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1551 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1552 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001553
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001554tune.chksize <number>
1555 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1556 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1557 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1558 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1559 checks whenever possible.
1560
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001561tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1562 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1563 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1564 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1565 this value. The default value is 1.
1566
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001567tune.fail-alloc
1568 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1569 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1570 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1571 gracefully.
1572
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001573tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1574 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1575 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1576 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1577 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1578 change it.
1579
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001580tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1581 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001582 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1583 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001584 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1585 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1586 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1587 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1588 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1589
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001590tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1591 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1592 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1593 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1594 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1595 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1596 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1597 recommended not to change this value.
1598
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001599tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1600 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1601 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1602 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1603 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1604 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1605 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1606 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1607
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001608tune.http.cookielen <number>
1609 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1610 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1611 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1612 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1613 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1614 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1615 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1616 to change this value.
1617
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001618tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001619 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1620 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001621 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001622 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001623 configuration directives too.
1624 The default value is 1024.
1625
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001626tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1627 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1628 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1629 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1630 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1631 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1632 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001633 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1634 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1635 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001636
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001637tune.idletimer <timeout>
1638 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1639 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1640 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1641 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1642 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1643 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001644 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001645 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1646 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1647
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001648tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1649 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1650 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1651 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1652 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1653 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1654 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1655 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1656 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1657 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1658
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001659tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1660 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001661 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001662 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1663 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001664 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001665 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1666 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1667
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001668tune.lua.maxmem
1669 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1670 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1671 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1672 memory.
1673
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001674tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1675 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001676 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1677 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001678 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001679
1680tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1681 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1682 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1683 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1684 check servers.
1685
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001686tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1687 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1688 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1689 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001690 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001691
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001692tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001693 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1694 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1695 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1696 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1697 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1698 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1699 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1700 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1701 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1702 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001703
1704tune.maxpollevents <number>
1705 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1706 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1707 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1708 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1709 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1710
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001711tune.maxrewrite <number>
1712 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1713 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1714 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1715 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1716 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1717 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1718 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1719 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1720 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1721 bufsize.
1722
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001723tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1724 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1725 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1726 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1727 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1728 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1729 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1730 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1731 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1732 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1733 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1734 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1735 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1736 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1737 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1738 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1739 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1740 setting this parameter to 0.
1741
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001742tune.pipesize <number>
1743 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1744 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1745 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1746 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1747 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1748 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1749
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001750tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1751tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1752 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1753 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1754 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1755 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001756 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001757 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1758 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1759
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001760tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001761 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001762 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1763 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1764 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1765 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1766
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001767tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1768 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1769 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1770 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1771
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001772tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1773tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1774 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1775 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1776 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1777 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001778 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001779 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1780 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1781 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1782 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1783 notifying haproxy again.
1784
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001785tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001786 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1787 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1788 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001789 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001790 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001791 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001792 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1793 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1794 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001795 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1796 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001797
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001798tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001799 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001800 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1801 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1802 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1803 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1804 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1805
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001806tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1807 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001808 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001809 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1810 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1811 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1812 being used for too long.
1813
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001814tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1815 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1816 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1817 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1818 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1819 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1820 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1821 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1822 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1823 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1824 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001825 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001826 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001827
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001828tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1829 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1830 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1831 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1832 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1833 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1834 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1835 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001836 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1837 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001838
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001839tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1840 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1841 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1842 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1843 1000 entries.
1844
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001845tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1846 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1847 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1848 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1849
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001850tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001851tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001852tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1853tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1854tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001855 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1856 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1857 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1858 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1859 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1860 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1861 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1862 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001863
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001864 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1865 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1866 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1867 all available space is consumed.
1868 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1869 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1870 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001871
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001872tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1873 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001874 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001875 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001877 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1878
1879tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1880 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1881 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1883 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018853.3. Debugging
1886--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001887
1888debug
1889 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1890 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1891 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1892 system startup.
1893
1894quiet
1895 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1896 line argument "-q".
1897
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018993.4. Userlists
1900--------------
1901It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1902http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1903it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1904
1905userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001906 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001907 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1908
1909group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001910 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001911 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1912 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1913
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001914user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1915 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001916 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1917 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001918 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1919 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1920 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1921 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001922
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001923 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1924 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1925 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1926 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1927 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1928 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1929 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1930 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1931 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001932
1933 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001934 userlist L1
1935 group G1 users tiger,scott
1936 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001937
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001938 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1939 user scott insecure-password elgato
1940 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001942 userlist L2
1943 group G1
1944 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001945
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001946 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1947 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1948 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001949
1950 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001951
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001952
19533.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001954----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001955It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1956several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1957instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1958values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1959automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1960In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1961using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1962tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1963reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1964Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1965that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1966each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001967
1968peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001969 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001970 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1971
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001972bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1973 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1974 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1975
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001976disabled
1977 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1978 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1979 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1980
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001981default-bind [param*]
1982 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1983
1984default-server [param*]
1985 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1986
1987 Arguments:
1988 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1989 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1990 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1991 details.
1992
1993
1994 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1995
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001996enable
1997 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1998
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001999peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002000 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2001 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2002 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2003 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2004 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2005 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2006
2007 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2008 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2009
2010 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2011 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2012 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2013 across all peers.
2014
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002015 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2016 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002017
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002018 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2019 "server" keyword explanation below).
2020
2021server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2022 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2023 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2024 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2025 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2026 of this "peers" section).
2027 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2028
2029
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002030 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002031 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002032 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002033 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2034 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2035 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002036
2037 backend mybackend
2038 mode tcp
2039 balance roundrobin
2040 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2041 stick on src
2042
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002043 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2044 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002045
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002046 Example:
2047 peers mypeers
2048 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2049 default-server ssl verify none
2050 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2051 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002052
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020533.6. Mailers
2054------------
2055It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2056If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2057in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2058
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002059mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002060 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2061 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2062
2063mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2064 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2065
2066 Example:
2067 mailers mymailers
2068 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2069 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2070
2071 backend mybackend
2072 mode tcp
2073 balance roundrobin
2074
2075 email-alert mailers mymailers
2076 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2077 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2078
2079 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2080 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2081
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002082timeout mail <time>
2083 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2084 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2085 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2086 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2087
2088 Example:
2089 mailers mymailers
2090 timeout mail 20s
2091 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002094----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002096Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002097 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002098 - frontend <name>
2099 - backend <name>
2100 - listen <name>
2101
2102A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2103its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2104section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002105section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002106
2107A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2108connections.
2109
2110A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2111to forward incoming connections.
2112
2113A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2114parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2117'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2118case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2119
2120Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2121logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2122proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2123However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2124name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2125
2126Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2127and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002128bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2130modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2131arbitrary criteria.
2132
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002133In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2134a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002135the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002136
2137 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2138 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2139 between responses and new requests.
2140
2141 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2142 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2143 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002144 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2145 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002146
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002147 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2148 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2149 client-facing connection remains open.
2150
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002151 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2152 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002153
2154The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2155frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2156following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002157weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002158
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002159 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002160
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002161 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2162 ----+-----+-----+----
2163 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2164 ----+-----+-----+----
2165 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2166 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2167 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2168 ----+-----+-----+----
2169 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021734.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2174--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002176The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2177limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2178they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2179limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002180marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002181option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002182and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2183with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2184specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002186
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002187 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2188------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2189acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002190appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002191backlog X X X -
2192balance X - X X
2193bind - X X -
2194bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002195block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002196capture cookie - X X -
2197capture request header - X X -
2198capture response header - X X -
2199clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002200compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002201contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2202cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002203declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002204default-server X - X X
2205default_backend X X X -
2206description - X X X
2207disabled X X X X
2208dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002209email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002210email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002211email-alert mailers X X X X
2212email-alert myhostname X X X X
2213email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002214enabled X X X X
2215errorfile X X X X
2216errorloc X X X X
2217errorloc302 X X X X
2218-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2219errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002220force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002221filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002222fullconn X - X X
2223grace X X X X
2224hash-type X - X X
2225http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002226http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002227http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002228http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002229http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002230http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002231http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002232id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002233ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002234load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002235log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002236log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002237log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002238log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002239max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002240maxconn X X X -
2241mode X X X X
2242monitor fail - X X -
2243monitor-net X X X -
2244monitor-uri X X X -
2245option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2246option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2247option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2248option allbackups (*) X - X X
2249option checkcache (*) X - X X
2250option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2251option contstats (*) X X X -
2252option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2253option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002254option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002255-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2256option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002257option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002258option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002259option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002260option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002261option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002262option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002263option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002264option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002265option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266option httpchk X - X X
2267option httpclose (*) X X X X
2268option httplog X X X X
2269option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002270option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002271option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002272option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002273option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2274option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2275option logasap (*) X X X -
2276option mysql-check X - X X
2277option nolinger (*) X X X X
2278option originalto X X X X
2279option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002280option pgsql-check X - X X
2281option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002282option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002283option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002284option smtpchk X - X X
2285option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2286option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2287option splice-request (*) X X X X
2288option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002289option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002290option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2291option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2292-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002293option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002294option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2295option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2296option tcpka X X X X
2297option tcplog X X X X
2298option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002299external-check command X - X X
2300external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002301persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2302rate-limit sessions X X X -
2303redirect - X X X
2304redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2305redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2306reqadd - X X X
2307reqallow - X X X
2308reqdel - X X X
2309reqdeny - X X X
2310reqiallow - X X X
2311reqidel - X X X
2312reqideny - X X X
2313reqipass - X X X
2314reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002315reqitarpit - X X X
2316reqpass - X X X
2317reqrep - X X X
2318-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002319reqtarpit - X X X
2320retries X - X X
2321rspadd - X X X
2322rspdel - X X X
2323rspdeny - X X X
2324rspidel - X X X
2325rspideny - X X X
2326rspirep - X X X
2327rsprep - X X X
2328server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002329server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002330server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002331source X - X X
2332srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002333stats admin - X X X
2334stats auth X X X X
2335stats enable X X X X
2336stats hide-version X X X X
2337stats http-request - X X X
2338stats realm X X X X
2339stats refresh X X X X
2340stats scope X X X X
2341stats show-desc X X X X
2342stats show-legends X X X X
2343stats show-node X X X X
2344stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002345-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2346stick match - - X X
2347stick on - - X X
2348stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002349stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002350stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002351tcp-check connect - - X X
2352tcp-check expect - - X X
2353tcp-check send - - X X
2354tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002355tcp-request connection - X X -
2356tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002357tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002358tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002359tcp-response content - - X X
2360tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002361timeout check X - X X
2362timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002363timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002364timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2365timeout connect X - X X
2366timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2367timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2368timeout http-request X X X X
2369timeout queue X - X X
2370timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002371timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002372timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2373timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002374timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002375transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002376unique-id-format X X X -
2377unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002378use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002379use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002380------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2381 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023844.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2385---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386
2387This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2388
2389
2390acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2391 Declare or complete an access list.
2392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2393 no | yes | yes | yes
2394 Example:
2395 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2396 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2397 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002399 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400
2401
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002402appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2403 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2406 no | no | yes | yes
2407 Arguments :
2408 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2409 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2410
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002411 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002412 checked in each cookie value.
2413
2414 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2415 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2416 milliseconds.
2417
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002418 request-learn
2419 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2420 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2421 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2422 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2423 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2424 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2425
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002426 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2427 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2428 data following this prefix.
2429
2430 Example :
2431 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2432
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002433 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2434 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002435
2436 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2437 2 modes are currently supported :
2438 - path-parameters :
2439 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2440 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2441 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2442 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2443 - query-string :
2444 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2445 query string.
2446
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002447 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2448 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2449 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002451 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2452 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002453
2454
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002455backlog <conns>
2456 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2458 yes | yes | yes | no
2459 Arguments :
2460 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2461 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002462 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002463
2464 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2465 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2466 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2467 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2468 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2469 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2470 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2471 backlog parameter.
2472
2473 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2474 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2475 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2476
2477 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2478
2479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002481balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 yes | no | yes | yes
2485 Arguments :
2486 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2487 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2488 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2489 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2490
2491 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2492 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2493 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2494 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002495 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002496 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002497 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2498 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2499 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2500 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2501 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2502 it, so that you don't worry.
2503
2504 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2505 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2506 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2507 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2508 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2509 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2510 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2511 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002513 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2514 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2515 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2516 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2517 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2518 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2519 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2520 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2521
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002522 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002523 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002524 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2525 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002526 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002527 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2528 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2529 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2530 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2531 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002532 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2533 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2534 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2535 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2536 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2537 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002539 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2540 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2541 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2542 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2543 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2544 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2545 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2546 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002547 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002549 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2550 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2551 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002552
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002553 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2554 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2555 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2556 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2557 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2558 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2559 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2560 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2561 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2562 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2563 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2564 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002565
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002566 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002567 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2568 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2569 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2570 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2571 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2572 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2573 URIs start with a leading "/".
2574
2575 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2576 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2577 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2578 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002581 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2582
2583 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002584 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2585 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002586 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2587 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2588 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2589 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002590 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002591 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2592 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002593
2594 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2595 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2596 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2597 server will receive the request.
2598
2599 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2600 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2601 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2602 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2603 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002604 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2605 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2606 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002608 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2609 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2610 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2611 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2612 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002614 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002615 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2616 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2617 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2618
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002619 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2620 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2621 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2622
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002623 random
2624 random(<draws>)
2625 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002626 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2627 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2628 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2629 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002630 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2631 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2632 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2633 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2634 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2635 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2636 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2637 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2638 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2639 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2640 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2641 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2642 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2643 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2644 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2645 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2646 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2647 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2648 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2649 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002650
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002651 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002652 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002653 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2654 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2655 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2656 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2657 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2658 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002659 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002660 used instead.
2661
2662 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2663 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2664 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2665 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2666
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002667 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2668 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2669 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2670
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002671 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002674 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2675 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002676
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002677 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2678 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2679 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002681 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2682 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2683 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2684 NTLM relies on.
2685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686 Examples :
2687 balance roundrobin
2688 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002689 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002690 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2691 balance hdr(host)
2692 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002693
2694 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2695 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002697 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002698 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2699 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2700 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2701 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2702
2703 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2704 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2705 defaults to 16 kB.
2706
2707 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2708 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2709
2710 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2711 Round Robin.
2712
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002713 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002714 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2715 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2716 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2717
2718 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2719
2720 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002721 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002722 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2723 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2724 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002726 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727
2728
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002729bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2730bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2733 no | yes | yes | no
2734 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002735 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2736 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2737 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2738 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002739 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002740 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2741 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2742 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2743 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2744 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2745 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2746 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002747 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2748 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2749 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2750 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2751 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2752 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2753 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002754 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2755 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2756 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002757 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2758 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2759 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2760 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002761 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2762 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2763 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002764
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002765 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2766 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002767 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2768 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2769 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002770 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2771 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2772 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2773 the range.
2774
2775 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2776 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2777 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2778 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2779 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2780 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2781 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002782 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002783 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002784
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002785 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002786 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002787 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2788 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2789 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2790 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2791 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2792 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2793
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002794 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2795 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2796 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2797 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002798
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2800 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2801 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2802 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2803 in a frontend.
2804
2805 Example :
2806 listen http_proxy
2807 bind :80,:443
2808 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002809 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002811 listen http_https_proxy
2812 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002813 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002814
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002815 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2816 bind ipv6@:80
2817 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2818 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2819
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002820 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002821 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002822
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002823 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2824 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2825 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2826 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2827 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2828
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002829 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002830 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002831
2832
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002833bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002834 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2836 yes | yes | yes | yes
2837 Arguments :
2838 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2839 may be used to override a default value.
2840
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002841 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002842 option may be combined with other numbers.
2843
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002844 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002845 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2846 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2847 missing from all processes.
2848
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002849 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002850 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002851 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2852 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2853 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2854 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2855 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002856 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002857
2858 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2859 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2860 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2861 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2862 and 'even' instances.
2863
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002864 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2865 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2866 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2867 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002868
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002869 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2870 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2871
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002872 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2873 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2874 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2875
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002876 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2877 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2878
2879 Example :
2880 listen app_ip1
2881 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002882 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002883
2884 listen app_ip2
2885 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002886 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002887
2888 listen management
2889 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002890 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002891
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002892 listen management
2893 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2894 bind-process 1-4
2895
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002896 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002897
2898
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002899block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2902 no | yes | yes | yes
2903
2904 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2905 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002906 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002907 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002909 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2910 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2911 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002913 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2914 "http-request deny" instead.
2915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002916 Example:
2917 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2918 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2919 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002920 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2921 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2922 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002924 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2925 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2926 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002927
2928capture cookie <name> len <length>
2929 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2931 no | yes | yes | no
2932 Arguments :
2933 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2934 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2935 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2936 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002937 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938
2939 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2940 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2941 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2942 right if it exceeds <length>.
2943
2944 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2945 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2946 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2947 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2948
2949 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2950 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2951 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2952
2953 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2954 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2955 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002956 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2957 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2958 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959
2960 Example:
2961 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2962
2963 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002964 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
2966
2967capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002968 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2970 no | yes | yes | no
2971 Arguments :
2972 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002973 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002974 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2975 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2976 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2977
2978 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2979 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2980 it exceeds <length>.
2981
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002982 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002983 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2984 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002985 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2986 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2987 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2988 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002989 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002990 environments to find where the request came from.
2991
2992 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2993 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2994 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2995 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002996
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002997 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2998 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2999 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3000 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3001 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003002
3003 Example:
3004 capture request header Host len 15
3005 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003006 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003008 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003009 about logging.
3010
3011
3012capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003013 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3015 no | yes | yes | no
3016 Arguments :
3017 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003018 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003019 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3020 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3021 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3022
3023 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3024 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3025 it exceeds <length>.
3026
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003027 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3029 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3030 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003031 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3032 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3033 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3034 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003036 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3037 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3038 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3039 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3040 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041
3042 Example:
3043 capture response header Content-length len 9
3044 capture response header Location len 15
3045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003046 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047 about logging.
3048
3049
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003050clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003051 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3053 yes | yes | yes | no
3054 Arguments :
3055 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3056 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3057 as explained at the top of this document.
3058
3059 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3060 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3061 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3062 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3063 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3064 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3065 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3066 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003067 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003069 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3072 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3073 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3074 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3075 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3076 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3077
3078 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3079 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3080
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003081 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3082 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003084compression algo <algorithm> ...
3085compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003086compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003087 Enable HTTP compression.
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3089 yes | yes | yes | yes
3090 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003091 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3092 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3093 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3094
3095 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003096 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3097 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3098 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003099
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003100 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003101 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003102
3103 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3104 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3105 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3106 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3107 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003108 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003109
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003110 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3111 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3112 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3113 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3114 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3115 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3116 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003117 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003118
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003119 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003120 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003121 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3122 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3123 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3124 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3125 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003126
3127 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3128 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3129 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3130 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3131 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003132 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3133 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3134 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3135 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3136 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003137 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3138 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003139
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003140 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003141 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3142 "Accept-Encoding" header
3143 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003144 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003145 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3146 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3147 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3148 "multipart"
3149 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3150 header
3151 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3152 and later
3153 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3154 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003155 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003156
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003157 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003158
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003159 Examples :
3160 compression algo gzip
3161 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003163
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003164contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3167 yes | no | yes | yes
3168 Arguments :
3169 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3170 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3171 as explained at the top of this document.
3172
3173 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003174 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003175 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003176 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003177 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3178 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3179 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3180
3181 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3182 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3183 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3184 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3185 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3186 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3187
3188 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3189 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3190 instead.
3191
3192 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3193 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3194
3195
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003196cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003197 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3198 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003199 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3202 yes | no | yes | yes
3203 Arguments :
3204 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3205 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3206 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3207 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3208 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3209 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003210 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003211 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3212 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3213
3214 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3215 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3216 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3217 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3218 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3219 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003220 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3221 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003222 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003223 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3224 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003227 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003228
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003229 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003230 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3231 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003232 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003233 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3234 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3235 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3236 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3237 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3238 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3239 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240
3241 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3242 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3243 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3244 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3245 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3246 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3247 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3248 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3249 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003250 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003251 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3252 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3253 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003254
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003255 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3256 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3257 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003258 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3259 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3260 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3261 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003262 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3263 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3264 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003265
3266 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3267 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3268 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3269 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3270 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3271 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3272 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3273 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3274 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3275
3276 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3277 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3278 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3279 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3280 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3281 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3282 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3283 persistence cookie in the cache.
3284 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3285
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003286 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3287 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3288 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3289 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3290 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003291 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003292 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3293 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3294 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3295 they logout.
3296
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003297 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3298 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3299 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3300 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3301
3302 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3303 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3304 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3305 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3306 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3307 this attribute.
3308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003309 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003310 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003311 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3312 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3313 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3314 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3315 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3316 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003317
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003318 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3319 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3320 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3321 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3322 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3323 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3324 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3325 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003326 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003327 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3328 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3329 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3330 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3331 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3332 the site.
3333
3334 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3335 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3336 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3337 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3338 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3339 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3340 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3341 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3342 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3343 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3344 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3345 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3346 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003347 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003348 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3349 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3350
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003351 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3352 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3353 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3354 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3355 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3356 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3359 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3360 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3361 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363 Examples :
3364 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3365 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3366 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003367 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003369 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003371
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003372declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3373 Declares a capture slot.
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 no | yes | yes | no
3376 Arguments:
3377 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3378
3379 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3380 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3381 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3382 for use in the response.
3383
3384 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003385 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003386 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3387
3388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003389default-server [param*]
3390 Change default options for a server in a backend
3391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3392 yes | no | yes | yes
3393 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003394 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3395 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3396 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3397 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003399 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003400 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3401
3402 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003403
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405default_backend <backend>
3406 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3408 yes | yes | yes | no
3409 Arguments :
3410 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3411
3412 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3413 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3414 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3415 will catch all undetermined requests.
3416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003417 Example :
3418
3419 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3420 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3421 default_backend dynamic
3422
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003423 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003426description <string>
3427 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 no | yes | yes | yes
3430 Arguments : string
3431
3432 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3433 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3434 it describes.
3435 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3436
3437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438disabled
3439 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 yes | yes | yes | yes
3442 Arguments : none
3443
3444 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3445 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3446 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3447 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3448 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3449 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3450 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3451
3452 See also : "enabled"
3453
3454
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003455dispatch <address>:<port>
3456 Set a default server address
3457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3458 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003459 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003460
3461 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3462 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3463 during start-up.
3464
3465 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3466 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3467 possible with normal servers.
3468
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003469 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003470 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3471 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3472 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3473 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3474
3475 See also : "server"
3476
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003477
3478dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3479 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3481 yes | no | yes | yes
3482 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3483
3484 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003485 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003486 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3487 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003488 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003489 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491enabled
3492 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3494 yes | yes | yes | yes
3495 Arguments : none
3496
3497 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3498 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3499
3500 See also : "disabled"
3501
3502
3503errorfile <code> <file>
3504 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | yes | yes | yes
3507 Arguments :
3508 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003509 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3510 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511
3512 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003513 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003515 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3516 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517
3518 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3519 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3520 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3521
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003522 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003524 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3525 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3526 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3527 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3528
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003529 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3530 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003531 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003532 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3533 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3534 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003536 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3537 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3538 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003539 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3541
3542 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3543
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003544 Example :
3545 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003546 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003547 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3548 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003550
3551errorloc <code> <url>
3552errorloc302 <code> <url>
3553 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3555 yes | yes | yes | yes
3556 Arguments :
3557 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003558 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3559 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560
3561 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3562 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3563 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3564 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003565 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003566
3567 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3568 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3569 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3570
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003571 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3572
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003573 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3574 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3575 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3576 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003577 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003578 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3579 request.
3580
3581 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3582
3583
3584errorloc303 <code> <url>
3585 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | yes
3588 Arguments :
3589 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003590 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3591 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003592
3593 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3594 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3595 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3596 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003597 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598
3599 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3600 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3601 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3602
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003603 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3604
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003605 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3606 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3607 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3608 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003609 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003610
3611 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3612
3613
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003614email-alert from <emailaddr>
3615 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003616 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | yes | yes | yes
3619
3620 Arguments :
3621
3622 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3623
3624 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3625 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3626
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003627 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003628 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3629 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003630
3631
3632email-alert level <level>
3633 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3634 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3635 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3636 yes | yes | yes | yes
3637
3638 Arguments :
3639
3640 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3641 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3642 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3643
3644 By default level is alert
3645
3646 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3647 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3648 for the proxy.
3649
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003650 Alerts are sent when :
3651
3652 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3653 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3654 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3655 is notice or lower
3656 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3657 and a health check status update occurs
3658
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003659 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3660 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003661 section 3.6 about mailers.
3662
3663
3664email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3665 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3666 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3667 yes | yes | yes | yes
3668
3669 Arguments :
3670
3671 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3672
3673 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3674 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3675
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003676 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3677 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003678
3679
3680email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3681 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3682 mailers.
3683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3684 yes | yes | yes | yes
3685
3686 Arguments :
3687
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003688 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003689
3690 By default the systems hostname is used.
3691
3692 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3693 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3694 for the proxy.
3695
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003696 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3697 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003698
3699
3700email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003701 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003702 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | yes | yes | yes
3705
3706 Arguments :
3707
3708 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3709
3710 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3711 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3712
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003713 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003714 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3715
3716
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003717force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3718 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003720 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003721
3722 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3723 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3724 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3725 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3726 marked down for maintenance operations.
3727
3728 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3729 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3730 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3731 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3732 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3733 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3734 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3735 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3736 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3737
3738 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3739 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3740 is used.
3741
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003742 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003743 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003744
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003745
3746filter <name> [param*]
3747 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 no | yes | yes | yes
3750 Arguments :
3751 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3752 referenced in section 9.
3753
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003754 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003755 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003756 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3757 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003758
3759 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3760 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3761
3762 Example:
3763 listen
3764 bind *:80
3765
3766 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3767 filter compression
3768 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3769
3770 compression algo gzip
3771 compression offload
3772
3773 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3774
3775 See also : section 9.
3776
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003777
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003778fullconn <conns>
3779 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | no | yes | yes
3782 Arguments :
3783 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3784 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3785
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003786 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003787 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003788 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003789 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3790 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3791 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3792 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3793 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003794 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003795
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003796 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3797 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003798 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3799 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3800 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003801
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003802 Example :
3803 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3804 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3805 # connections.
3806 backend dynamic
3807 fullconn 10000
3808 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3809 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3810
3811 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3812
3813
3814grace <time>
3815 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003818 Arguments :
3819 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3820 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3821 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3822
3823 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3824 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003825 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003826 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3827
3828 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3829 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3830 simplify it.
3831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003832
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003833hash-balance-factor <factor>
3834 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 yes | no | no | yes
3837 Arguments :
3838 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3839 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3840 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3841
3842 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3843 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3844 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3845 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3846 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3847 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3848 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3849
3850 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3851 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3852 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3853 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3854 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3855
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003856 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3857 consistent hashing mechanism.
3858
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003859 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3860
3861
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003862hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003863 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | no | yes | yes
3866 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003867 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3868 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003869
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003870 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3871 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3872 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3873 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3874 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3875 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3876 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3877 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3878 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3879 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003880
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003881 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3882 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3883 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3884 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3885 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3886 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3887 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3888 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3889 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3890 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3891 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3892 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3893 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003894 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3895 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003896
3897 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3898
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003899 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003900 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3901 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3902 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003903 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3904 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3905 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003906
3907 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3908 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003909 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3910 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3911 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3912 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3913
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003914 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3915 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3916 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3917 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3918 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3919 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3920 parameter.
3921
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003922 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3923 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3924 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3925 used on strings.
3926
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003927 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3928
3929 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3930 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3931 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3932 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3933 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3934 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3935 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3936 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3937 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3938 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3939 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3940 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003941
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003942 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3943 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3944 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003945
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003946 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003947
3948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003949http-check disable-on-404
3950 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003953 Arguments : none
3954
3955 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3956 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3957 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3958 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3959 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3960 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3961 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3962 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003963 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3964 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3965 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3966
3967 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3968
3969
3970http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003971 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003973 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003974 Arguments :
3975 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3976 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003977 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003978 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3979 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3980 details on the supported keywords.
3981
3982 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3983 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3984 with the usual backslash ('\').
3985
3986 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3987 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3988 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3989 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3990 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3991
3992 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003993 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003994 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3995 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3996 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3997
3998 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003999 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004000 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4001 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4002 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4003 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4004
4005 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004006 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004007 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4008 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4009 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4010 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4011 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004012 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004013 trace).
4014
4015 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004016 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004017 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4018 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4019 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4020 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4021 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004022 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004023
4024 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4025 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4026 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4027 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4028 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4029 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4030 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4031 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4032
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004033 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4034 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4035 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4036
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004037 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4038 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4039
4040 Examples :
4041 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004042 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004043
4044 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004045 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004046
4047 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004048 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004049
4050 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004051 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004052
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004053 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004054
4055
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004056http-check send-state
4057 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4059 yes | no | yes | yes
4060 Arguments : none
4061
4062 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4063 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4064 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4065 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4066 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4067
4068 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4069 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4070 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4071 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4072 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004073 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4074 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4075 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4076
4077 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4078 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4079 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4080
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004081 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4082 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4083 checked in multiple backends.
4084
4085 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4086 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4087
4088 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4089 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4090 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4091 one fails.
4092
4093 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4094 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4095 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4096
4097 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4098 server's queue.
4099
4100 Example of a header received by the application server :
4101 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4102 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4103
4104 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004106
4107http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004108 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4109
4110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 no | yes | yes | yes
4112
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004113 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4114 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4115 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4116 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4117 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004119 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4120 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004122 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004124 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4125 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4126 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4127 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004129 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4130 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4131 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4132 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004134 Example:
4135 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4136 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4137 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004139 http-request allow if nagios
4140 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4141 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4142 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004144 Example:
4145 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4146 acl add path /addacl
4147 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004149 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004151 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4152 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154 Example:
4155 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4156 acl setmap path /setmap
4157 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004159 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4162 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004164 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4165 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004167http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004169 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4170 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4171 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4172 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4173 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4174 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4175 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4176 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004178http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004180 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4181 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4182 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4183 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4184 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4185 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4186 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4187 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004191 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4192 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004193
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4198 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4199 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4200 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4201 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203 Example:
4204 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4205 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004206
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004207http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004211http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4212 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4215 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4216 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4217 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4218 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4219 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4220 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4221 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4222 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4225 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4226 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4227 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4228 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4229 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4234 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4235 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4236 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4237 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4238 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4247 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4248 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4249 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4250 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4251 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004255 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4256 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4257 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4258 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4259 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004260
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004261http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4262
4263 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4264 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4265 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4266 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004267 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4268 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004269
4270 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4275 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4276 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4277 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4278 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4283 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4284 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4285 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4291 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4292 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4293 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4294 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4295 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4296 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4297 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 Example:
4300 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004302 # applied to:
4303 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 # outputs:
4306 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4311 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4314 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4315 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4316 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318 Example:
4319 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 # applied to:
4322 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 # outputs:
4325 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4328http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4331 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4332 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4337 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4338 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4343 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4344 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4345 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4346 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 Arguments:
4349 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4350 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004352 Example:
4353 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4354 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4357 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4362 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4363 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 Arguments:
4366 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4367 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 Example:
4370 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4371 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4374 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4375 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004378
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004379 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4380 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4381 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4382 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4383 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004385 Example:
4386 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4387 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4388 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4389 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4390 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4391 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4392 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4393 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4394 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4399 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4400 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4401 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4402 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4408 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4409 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4410 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4411 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4412 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4413 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4414 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4415 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004419 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4420 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4421 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4422 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4423 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4424 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4425 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4430 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4431 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4436 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4437 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4438 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4439 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4440 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4441 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4442 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004446 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4447 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4448 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4449 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4450 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4451 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004452
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004453 Example :
4454 # prepend the host name before the path
4455 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004457http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004459 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4460 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4461 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4462 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4463 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4468 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4469 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4470 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4471 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4472 values have higher priority.
4473 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4474 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4475 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4476 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4477 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004479http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004481 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4482 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4483 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4484 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4485 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4486 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4487 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004489 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004490
4491 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4493 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004495http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4496 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4497 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4498 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4499 privacy.
4500
4501 Arguments :
4502 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4503 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004504
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004505 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004506 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4507 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4508
4509 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4510 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4511
4512http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4513
4514 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4515 expression.
4516
4517 Arguments:
4518 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4519 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004520
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004521 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4523 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4524
4525 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4526 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4527 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4528
4529http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4530
4531 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4532 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4533 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4534 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4535 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4536 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4537 information from the request.
4538
4539 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4540
4541http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4542
4543 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4544 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4545 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4546 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4547 path and the query string.
4548 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4549
4550http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4551
4552 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4553 inline.
4554
4555 Arguments:
4556 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4557 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4558 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4559 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4560 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4561 (request and response)
4562 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4563 processing
4564 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4565 processing
4566 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4567 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4568 and '_'.
4569
4570 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4571 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004572
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004573 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004576http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4577 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4580 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4581 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4582 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4583 agent name must be used.
4584
4585 Arguments:
4586 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4587
4588 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4589 configuration.
4590
4591http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4592
4593 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4594 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4595 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4596 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4597 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4598 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4599 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4600 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4601 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4602 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4603 action.
4604 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4605 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4606 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4607 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4608 you fully understand how it works.
4609
4610http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4611
4612 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4613 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4614 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4615 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4616 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4617 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4618 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4619 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4620 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4621 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4622 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4623 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4624 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4625
4626http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4627http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4628http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4629
4630 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4631 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4632 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4633 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4634 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4635 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4636 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4637 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4638 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4639 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4640 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4641 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4642
4643 Arguments :
4644 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4645 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4646 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4647 select which table entry to update the counters.
4648
4649 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4650 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4651 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4652 that table until the session ends.
4653
4654 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4655 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4656 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4657 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4658 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4659 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4660 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4661 useful information.
4662
4663 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4664 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4665 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4666 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4667 checks that make use of it.
4668
4669http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4670
4671 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004672
4673 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004676http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4679 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4680 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004681
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004684 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4685
4686 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 no | yes | yes | yes
4688
4689 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4690 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4691 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4692 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4693 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4694 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004696 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4697 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004698
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004699 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004701 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4702 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4703 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4704 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004706 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4707 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4708 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4709 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004710
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004711 Example:
4712 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004713
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004714 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004716 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4717 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004719 Example:
4720 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004722 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004724 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4725 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004726
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004727 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4728 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004730http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004732 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4733 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4734 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4735 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4736 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4737 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4738 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4739 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004741http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004743 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4744 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4745 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4746 example, or to pass some internal information.
4747 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4748 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4749 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004750
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004751http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004753 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4754 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004755
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004756http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004758 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004760http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4763 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4764 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4765 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4766 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4767 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4768 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004770 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4771 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4772 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4773 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4774 keyword.
4775 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4776 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004778http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004780 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4781 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4782 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4783 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4784 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4785 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004787http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004789 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004793 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4794 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4795 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4796 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4797 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4798 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004800http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004801
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004802 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4803 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004805http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004806
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004807 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4808 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4809 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4810 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4811 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4812 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004814http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4815 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004817 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4818 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4819 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4820 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4821 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4822 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4823 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4824 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004826 Example:
4827 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004828
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004829 # applied to:
4830 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004831
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004832 # outputs:
4833 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004835 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004837http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4838 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4841 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4842 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4843 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845 Example:
4846 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004848 # applied to:
4849 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004851 # outputs:
4852 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004854http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4855http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004857 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4858 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4859 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004860
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004861http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4864 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4865 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004868
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004869 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4870 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4871 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4872 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4873 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004875 Arguments:
4876 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004878 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4879 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4884 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4885 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004887http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4888
4889 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4890 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4891 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4892 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4893 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4894
4895http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4896
4897 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4898 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4899 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4900 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4901 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4902 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4903 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4904 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4905 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4906
4907http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4908
4909 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4910 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4911 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4912 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4913 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4914 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4915 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4916
4917http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4918
4919 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4920 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4921 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4922 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4923 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4924 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4925 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4926 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4927
4928http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4929 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4930
4931 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4932 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4933 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4934 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004935
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004936 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4938 http-response set-status 431
4939 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4940 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4945 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4946 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4947 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4948 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4949 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4950 based on some information from the request.
4951
4952 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4953
4954http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4955
4956 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4957 inline.
4958
4959 Arguments:
4960 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4961 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4962 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4963 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4964 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4965 (request and response)
4966 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4967 processing
4968 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4969 processing
4970 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4971 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4972 and '_'.
4973
4974 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4975 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004976
4977 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4983 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4984 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4985 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4986 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4987 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4988 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4989 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4990 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4991 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4992 action.
4993 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4994 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4995 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4996 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4997 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004999http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5000http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5001http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5004 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5005 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5006 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5007 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5008 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5009
5010http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5011
5012 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5013 about <var-name>.
5014
5015 Example:
5016 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5017
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005018
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005019http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5020 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5021
5022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 yes | no | yes | yes
5024
5025 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005026 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5027 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5028 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005029
5030 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5031
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005032 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5033 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5034 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5035 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5036 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5037 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5038 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5039 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5040 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5041 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005042
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005043 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5044 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5045 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5046 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5047 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5048 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5049 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5050 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005051
5052 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5053 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5054 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5055 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5056 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5057 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5058 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5059 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5060 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5061 downsides of rare connection failures.
5062
5063 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5064 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5065 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5066 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5067 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5068 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005069 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005070 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5071 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5072 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5073 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5074 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5075
5076 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005077 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5078 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5079 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005080
5081 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005082 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005083
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005084 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5085 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005086
5087 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5088 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5089 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5090
5091 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5092 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5093 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5094
5095 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5096
5097
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005098http-send-name-header [<header>]
5099 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5100
5101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 yes | no | yes | yes
5103
5104 Arguments :
5105
5106 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5107
5108 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005109 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005110 is added with the header string proved.
5111
5112 See also : "server"
5113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005114id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005115 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5117 no | yes | yes | yes
5118 Arguments : none
5119
5120 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5121 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5122 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005123
5124
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005125ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5126 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005128 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005129
5130 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5131 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5132 and running).
5133
5134 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5135 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5136 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005137 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005138 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5139
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005140 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5141 "unless" condition is met.
5142
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005143 Example:
5144 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5145 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5146 ignore-persist if url_static
5147
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005148 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5149
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005150load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5151 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5152 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5153 yes | no | yes | yes
5154
5155 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5156 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5157 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005158 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005159 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5160 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5161 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5162 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5163
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005164 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005165 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005166 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005167
5168 Arguments:
5169 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5170 named "server-state-file".
5171
5172 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5173 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5174 name is used as a file name.
5175
5176 none don't load any stat for this backend
5177
5178 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005179 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5180 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5181 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005182 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005183 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005184
5185 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5186 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5187
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005188 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005189
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005190 global
5191 stats socket /tmp/socket
5192 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005193
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005194 defaults
5195 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005196
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005197 backend bk
5198 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5199 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005200
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005201
5202 Then one can run :
5203
5204 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5205
5206 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5207
5208 1
5209 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5210 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5211 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5212
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005213 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005214
5215 global
5216 stats socket /tmp/socket
5217 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5218
5219 defaults
5220 load-server-state-from-file local
5221
5222 backend bk
5223 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5224 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5225
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005226
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005227 Then one can run :
5228
5229 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5230
5231 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5232
5233 1
5234 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5235 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5236 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5237
5238 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5239 "show servers state"
5240
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005241
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005242log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005243log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005244no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005245 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5247 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005248
5249 Prefix :
5250 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5251 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5252 prefix does not allow arguments.
5253
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005254 Arguments :
5255 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5256 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5257 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5258 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5259 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5260 parameter.
5261
5262 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5263 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5264
5265 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5266 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5267 standard syslog port).
5268
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005269 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5270 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5271 standard syslog port).
5272
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005273 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5274 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5275 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005276 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005277
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005278 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5279 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5280 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5281 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5282 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5283 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5284 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5285 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5286 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5287 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5288 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5289 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5290 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5291 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5292 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5293 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005294 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5295 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005296
5297 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5298 and "fd@2", see above.
5299
5300 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5301 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005302
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005303 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5304 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5305 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5306 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5307 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5308 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5309 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5310 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5311 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5312 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005313 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005314
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005315 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5316 one of the following :
5317
5318 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5319 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5320
5321 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5322 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5323
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005324 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5325 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5326 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5327 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5328 systemd logger consumes.
5329
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005330 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5331 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5332 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5333 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5334
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005335 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5336
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005337 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5338 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5339 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5340
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005341 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5342 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5343 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5344 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005345
5346 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5347 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5348 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005349 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5350 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5351 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5352 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5353 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005354
5355 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5356
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005357 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5358 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5359 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005360
5361 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5362 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5363 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5364 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5365
5366 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5367 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005368
5369 Example :
5370 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005371 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5372 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5373 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005374 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5375 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005376 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005377
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005378
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005379log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005380 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005383
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005384 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5385 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5386 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5387 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5388 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005389
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005390 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5391 "option httplog" directives.
5392
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005393log-format-sd <string>
5394 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 yes | yes | yes | no
5397
5398 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5399 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5400 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5401 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5402 which covers the log format string in depth.
5403
5404 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5405 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5406
5407 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5408 log format to "rfc5424".
5409
5410 Example :
5411 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5412
5413
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005414log-tag <string>
5415 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5417 yes | yes | yes | yes
5418
5419 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5420 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5421 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5422 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5423 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5424 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5425 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5426 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5427 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005428
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005429max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5430 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5432 yes | no | yes | yes
5433
5434 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5435 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5436 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5437 servers.
5438
5439 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5440 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5441 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5442 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5443 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005444 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005445 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5446 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5447 picking a different server.
5448
5449 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5450 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5451 even if they have to be queued.
5452
5453 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5454 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5455
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005456max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5457 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5458 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5459 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005460
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005461maxconn <conns>
5462 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5464 yes | yes | yes | no
5465 Arguments :
5466 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5467 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5468 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5469 closes.
5470
5471 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5472 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5473 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5474 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005475 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5476 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5477 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5478 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005479
5480 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5481 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5482 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5483
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005484 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5485 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005486
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005487 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5488
5489
5490mode { tcp|http|health }
5491 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | yes | yes | yes
5494 Arguments :
5495 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5496 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5497 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5498 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5499
5500 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5501 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5502 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5503 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5504 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5505
5506 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005507 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5508 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5509 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5510 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5511 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5512 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5513 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005514
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005515 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5516 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5517 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005518
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005519 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005520 defaults http_instances
5521 mode http
5522
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005523 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005525
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005526monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005527 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5529 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005530 Arguments :
5531 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5532 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005533 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005534 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5535 backend and its backup.
5536
5537 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5538 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5539 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5540 servers in a list of backends.
5541
5542 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5543 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5544 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5545 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5546 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5547 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5548 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005549 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5550 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005551
5552 Example:
5553 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005554 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005555 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5556 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5557 monitor-uri /site_alive
5558 monitor fail if site_dead
5559
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005560 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005561
5562
5563monitor-net <source>
5564 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5566 yes | yes | yes | no
5567 Arguments :
5568 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5569 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5570 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5571 followed by a mask.
5572
5573 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5574 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005575 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005576 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5577
5578 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5579 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5580 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5581 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005582 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5583 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5584 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005585
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005586 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5587 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5588 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5589 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5590 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5591 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005592
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005593 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5594 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005595
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005596 Example :
5597 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5598 frontend www
5599 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5600
5601 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5602
5603
5604monitor-uri <uri>
5605 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 yes | yes | yes | no
5608 Arguments :
5609 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5610 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5611
5612 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5613 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5614 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5615 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5616 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5617 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5618 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5619 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5620
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005621 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5622 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5623 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5624 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5625 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5626 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5627 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5628 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005629
5630 Example :
5631 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5632 frontend www
5633 mode http
5634 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5635
5636 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005638
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005639option abortonclose
5640no option abortonclose
5641 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5643 yes | no | yes | yes
5644 Arguments : none
5645
5646 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5647 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5648 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5649 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005650 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005651 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5652 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5653 encountered while delivering the response.
5654
5655 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5656 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5657 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5658 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5659 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5660 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005661 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005662 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005663 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005664 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5665 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5666 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5667
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005668 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5669 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005670 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5671 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5672 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5673 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5674 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5675 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005676 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005677
5678 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5679 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5680
5681 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5682
5683
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005684option accept-invalid-http-request
5685no option accept-invalid-http-request
5686 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 yes | yes | yes | no
5689 Arguments : none
5690
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005691 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005692 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005693 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005694 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5695 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5696 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5697 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5698 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005699 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5700 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5701 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5702 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005703 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005704 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005705 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5706 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5707 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005708
5709 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5710 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5711 been confirmed.
5712
5713 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5714 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005715 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5716 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005717 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5718
5719 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5720 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5721
5722 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5723 stats socket.
5724
5725
5726option accept-invalid-http-response
5727no option accept-invalid-http-response
5728 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 yes | no | yes | yes
5731 Arguments : none
5732
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005733 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005734 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005735 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005736 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5737 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5738 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5739 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5740 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005741 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5742 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5743 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005744
5745 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5746 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5747 been confirmed.
5748
5749 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5750 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5751 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5752 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5753
5754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5756
5757 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5758 stats socket.
5759
5760
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005761option allbackups
5762no option allbackups
5763 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5765 yes | no | yes | yes
5766 Arguments : none
5767
5768 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5769 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5770 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5771 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5772 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5773 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5774 order between the backup servers anymore.
5775
5776 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5777 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5778
5779 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5780 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5781
5782
5783option checkcache
5784no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005785 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5787 yes | no | yes | yes
5788 Arguments : none
5789
5790 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5791 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005792 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005793 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5794 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005795 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005796
5797 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005798 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005799 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005800 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5801 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005802 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005803 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005804 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5805 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005806 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005807 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5808 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005809 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005810 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5811 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5812 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5813 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5814 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5815 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5816 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5817 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5818 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5819
5820 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005821 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005822 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005823 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005824 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5825
5826 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5827 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005828 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005829 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005830
5831 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5832 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5833
5834
5835option clitcpka
5836no option clitcpka
5837 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5839 yes | yes | yes | no
5840 Arguments : none
5841
5842 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5843 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005844 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005845 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5846
5847 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5848 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5849 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5850 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5851
5852 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5853 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5854 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5855 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5856 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5857
5858 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5859
5860 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5861 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5862 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5863
5864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5866
5867 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5868
5869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005870option contstats
5871 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5873 yes | yes | yes | no
5874 Arguments : none
5875
5876 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5877 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5878 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5879 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005880 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5881 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5882 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5883 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5884 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005885
5886
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005887option dontlog-normal
5888no option dontlog-normal
5889 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5891 yes | yes | yes | no
5892 Arguments : none
5893
5894 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5895 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5896 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5897 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5898 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5899 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5900 logged.
5901
5902 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5903 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5904 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005906 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005907 logging.
5908
5909
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005910option dontlognull
5911no option dontlognull
5912 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5914 yes | yes | yes | no
5915 Arguments : none
5916
5917 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5918 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5919 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5920 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5921 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5922 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005923 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5924 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5925 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005926
5927 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005928 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005929 would not be logged.
5930
5931 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5932 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5933
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005934 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5935 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005936
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005937
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005938option forceclose (deprecated)
5939no option forceclose (deprecated)
5940 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005941
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005942 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005943
5944
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005945option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005946 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5948 yes | yes | yes | yes
5949 Arguments :
5950 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5951 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005952 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005953 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005954
5955 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5956 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5957 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5958 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5959 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5960 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5961 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005962 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5963 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5964 possible that the client has already brought one.
5965
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005966 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005967 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005968 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005969 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005970 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005971 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005972
5973 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5974 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5975 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5976 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5977 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5978 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5979 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5980
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005981 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5982 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5983 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5984 are under the control of the end-user.
5985
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005986 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005987 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5988 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005989 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5990 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5991 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005992
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005993 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005994 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5995 frontend www
5996 mode http
5997 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5998
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005999 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6000 backend www
6001 mode http
6002 option forwardfor header X-Client
6003
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006004 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006005 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006006
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006007
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006008option http-buffer-request
6009no option http-buffer-request
6010 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6012 yes | yes | yes | yes
6013 Arguments : none
6014
6015 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6016 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6017 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6018 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6019 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6020 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6021 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6022 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006023 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006024 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6025 default.
6026
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006027 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006028
6029
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006030option http-ignore-probes
6031no option http-ignore-probes
6032 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6034 yes | yes | yes | no
6035 Arguments : none
6036
6037 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6038 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6039 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6040 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6041 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6042 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6043 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6044 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6045 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006046 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6047 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006048 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6049
6050 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6051 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6052 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6053 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6054 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6055 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6056 are often the only way to detect them.
6057
6058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6060
6061 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6062
6063
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006064option http-keep-alive
6065no option http-keep-alive
6066 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6068 yes | yes | yes | yes
6069 Arguments : none
6070
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006071 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6072 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006073 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6074 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6075 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6076 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6077 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006078
6079 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6080 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006081 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6082 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6083 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6084 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6085 situations where this option may be useful :
6086
6087 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006088 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006089
6090 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6091 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6092
6093 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6094 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6095 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6096 request.
6097
6098 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6099 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006100 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6101 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6102 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006103
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006104 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6105 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6106 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6107 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6108 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6109 not set.
6110
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006111 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006112 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6113 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006114
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006115 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006116 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006117 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006118
6119
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006120option http-no-delay
6121no option http-no-delay
6122 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6124 yes | yes | yes | yes
6125 Arguments : none
6126
6127 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6128 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6129 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6130 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6131 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6132 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6133 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6134 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6135 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6136 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6137 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6138 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6139 affected.
6140
6141 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6142 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6143 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6144 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6145 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6146 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6147 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6148 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6149 latency environments.
6150
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006151 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6152
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006153
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006154option http-pretend-keepalive
6155no option http-pretend-keepalive
6156 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006158 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006159 Arguments : none
6160
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006161 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006162 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6163 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6164 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6165 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6166 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6167 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6168 consider the response complete.
6169
6170 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6171 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6172 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6173 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006174 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006175 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6176
6177 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6178 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6179 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6180 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6181 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6182 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6183 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6184
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006185 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6186 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6187 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6188 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6189 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6190 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006191
6192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6194
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006195 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006196 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006197
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006198
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006199option http-server-close
6200no option http-server-close
6201 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6203 yes | yes | yes | yes
6204 Arguments : none
6205
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006206 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6207 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6208 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6209 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006210 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6211 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6212 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6213 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6214 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6215 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6216 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6217 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6218 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6219 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6220 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006221
6222 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6223 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6224 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6225 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006226 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6227 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006228
6229 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6230 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006231 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6232 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6233 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006234
6235 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6236 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6237
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006238 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6239 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006240
6241
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006242option http-tunnel
6243no option http-tunnel
6244 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006246 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006247 Arguments : none
6248
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006249 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6250 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6251 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6252 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006253 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006254
6255 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006256 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006257 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6258 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6259 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6260 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6261 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6262 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6263 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006264
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006265 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6266 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6267 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6268 backend.
6269
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6272
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006273 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6274 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006275
6276
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006277option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006278no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006279 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6281 yes | yes | yes | no
6282 Arguments : none
6283
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006284 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006285 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6286 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6287 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6288 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6289 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6290 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6291
6292 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6293 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006294 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6295 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6296 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006297
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006298 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6299 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6300 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6301 front of an existing proxy.
6302
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006303 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6304
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006305 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006306
6307
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006308option http-use-htx
6309no option http-use-htx
6310 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6312 yes | yes | yes | yes
6313 Arguments : none
6314
6315 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6316 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6317 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6318 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6319 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6320 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6321 representation.
6322
6323 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6324 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6325 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6326 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6327 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6328 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6329 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6330 other side's version.
6331
6332 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6333 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6334 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6335 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6336 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6337
6338 See also : "mode http"
6339
6340
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006341option httpchk
6342option httpchk <uri>
6343option httpchk <method> <uri>
6344option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6345 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6347 yes | no | yes | yes
6348 Arguments :
6349 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6350 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6351 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6352 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6353 ones.
6354
6355 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6356 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6357 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6358
6359 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6360 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6361 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6362 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6363 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6364
6365 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6366 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6367 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6368 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6369 the lack of any response.
6370
6371 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6372
6373 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6374 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6375 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6376
6377 Examples :
6378 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6379 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6380 backend https_relay
6381 mode tcp
6382 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6383 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6384
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006385 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6386 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6387 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006388
6389
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006390option httpclose
6391no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006392 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6394 yes | yes | yes | yes
6395 Arguments : none
6396
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006397 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6398 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6399 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6400 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006401 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006402
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006403 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6404 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6405 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6406 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6407 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006408
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006409 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6410 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6411 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006412
6413 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6414 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006415 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006416 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6417 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6418 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006419
6420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6422
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006423 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006424
6425
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006426option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006427 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006429 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006430 Arguments :
6431 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6432 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6433 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006434 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006435 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006436
6437 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6438 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6439 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6440 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6441 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6442 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6443 ports.
6444
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006445 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6446 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006447
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006448 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006450 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006451
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006452
6453option http_proxy
6454no option http_proxy
6455 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 yes | yes | yes | yes
6458 Arguments : none
6459
6460 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6461 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6462 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6463 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6464 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6465
6466 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6467 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006468 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6469 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006470
6471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6473
6474 Example :
6475 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6476 backend direct_forward
6477 option httpclose
6478 option http_proxy
6479
6480 See also : "option httpclose"
6481
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006482
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006483option independent-streams
6484no option independent-streams
6485 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6487 yes | yes | yes | yes
6488 Arguments : none
6489
6490 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6491 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6492 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6493 receive data or not.
6494
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006495 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006496 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6497 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6498 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6499 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6500 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6501 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6502 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6503 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6504 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6505 socket buffers.
6506
6507 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6508 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6509 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6510 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6511 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6512
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006513 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006514 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6515 deprecated.
6516
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006517 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006518
6519
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006520option ldap-check
6521 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6523 yes | no | yes | yes
6524 Arguments : none
6525
6526 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6527 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6528 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6529 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6530
6531 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6532 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6533
6534 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6535 configure it.
6536
6537 Example :
6538 option ldap-check
6539
6540 See also : "option httpchk"
6541
6542
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006543option external-check
6544 Use external processes for server health checks
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 yes | no | yes | yes
6547
6548 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6549 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6550 command".
6551
6552 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6553
6554 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6555
6556
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006557option log-health-checks
6558no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006559 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6561 yes | no | yes | yes
6562 Arguments : none
6563
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006564 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6565 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6566 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006567
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006568 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6569 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6570 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6571 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6572 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6573
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006574 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006575 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006576
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006577 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6578 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6579 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006580
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006581
6582option log-separate-errors
6583no option log-separate-errors
6584 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6586 yes | yes | yes | no
6587 Arguments : none
6588
6589 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6590 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6591 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6592 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6593 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6594 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6595 provides very important information.
6596
6597 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6598 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6599 error logs.
6600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006601 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006602 logging.
6603
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006604
6605option logasap
6606no option logasap
6607 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6609 yes | yes | yes | no
6610 Arguments : none
6611
6612 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6613 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6614 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6615 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6616 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6617 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6618 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006619 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006620 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6621 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6622
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006623 Examples :
6624 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6625 mode http
6626 option httplog
6627 option logasap
6628 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6629
6630 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6631 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6632 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6633 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006635 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006636 logging.
6637
6638
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006639option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006640 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6642 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006643 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006644 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6645 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006646 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006647
6648 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6649 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006650 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006651 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6652 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6653 in the MySQL table, like this :
6654
6655 USE mysql;
6656 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6657 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6658
6659 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006660 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006661 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6662 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6663 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6664 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6665 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6666 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6667 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6668
6669 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6670 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006671
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006672 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006673
6674 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6675 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6676 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6677 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006678 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6679 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006680
6681 See also: "option httpchk"
6682
6683
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006684option nolinger
6685no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006686 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006687 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6688 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006689 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006690
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006691 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006692 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6693 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6694 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6695 connections.
6696
6697 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6698 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6699 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6700 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6701 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6702 this too.
6703
6704 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6705 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6706 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6707
6708 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6709 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6710 for servers.
6711
6712 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6713 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6714
6715
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006716option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6717 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6719 yes | yes | yes | yes
6720 Arguments :
6721 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6722 matching <network>
6723 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6724 header name.
6725
6726 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6727 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6728 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6729 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6730 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6731 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6732 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6733 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6734 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6735 possible that the client has already brought one.
6736
6737 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6738 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6739 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6740 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6741 header and requires different one.
6742
6743 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6744 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6745 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6746 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6747 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6748 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6749 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6750
6751 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6752 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6753 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6754 both are defined.
6755
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006756 Examples :
6757 # Original Destination address
6758 frontend www
6759 mode http
6760 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6761
6762 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6763 backend www
6764 mode http
6765 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6766
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006767 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006768
6769
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006770option persist
6771no option persist
6772 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6774 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006775 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006776
6777 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6778 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6779 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6780 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6781 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6782 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6783 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6784 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6785 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6786 redirected to another valid server.
6787
6788 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6789 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6790
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006791 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006792
6793
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006794option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6795 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6797 yes | no | yes | yes
6798 Arguments :
6799 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6800 PostgreSQL server.
6801
6802 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6803 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6804 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6805 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6806
6807 See also: "option httpchk"
6808
6809
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006810option prefer-last-server
6811no option prefer-last-server
6812 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6814 yes | no | yes | yes
6815 Arguments : none
6816
6817 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6818 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6819 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6820 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6821 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6822 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6823 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6824 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6825 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006826 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6827 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006828 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6829 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6830 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006831 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6832 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6833 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006834
6835 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6836 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6837
6838 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6839
6840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006841option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006842option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006843no option redispatch
6844 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6845 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6846 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006847 Arguments :
6848 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6849 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6850 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006851 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006852 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006853 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006854 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6855 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6856 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006858
6859 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6860 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6861 be able to access the service anymore.
6862
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006863 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6864 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006865
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006866 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006867 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6868 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006870 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6871 "redisp" keywords.
6872
6873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6875
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006876 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006877
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006878
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006879option redis-check
6880 Use redis health checks for server testing
6881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6882 yes | no | yes | yes
6883 Arguments : none
6884
6885 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6886 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6887 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6888 find the "+PONG" response message.
6889
6890 Example :
6891 option redis-check
6892
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006893 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006894
6895
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006896option smtpchk
6897option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6898 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6900 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006901 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006902 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006903 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006904 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6905
6906 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6907 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6908 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6909
6910 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6911 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6912 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6913 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6914 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6915 dead server.
6916
6917 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6918 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006919 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006920 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6921
6922 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6923 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6924 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6925 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006926 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006927
6928 Example :
6929 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6930
6931 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006933
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006934option socket-stats
6935no option socket-stats
6936
6937 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6939 yes | yes | yes | no
6940
6941 Arguments : none
6942
6943
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006944option splice-auto
6945no option splice-auto
6946 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6948 yes | yes | yes | yes
6949 Arguments : none
6950
6951 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6952 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006953 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006954 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006955 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006956 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6957 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6958 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6959 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6960
6961 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6962 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6963 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6964 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6965 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6966 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6967 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6968 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6969 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6970 keyword.
6971
6972 Example :
6973 option splice-auto
6974
6975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6977
6978 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6979 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6980
6981
6982option splice-request
6983no option splice-request
6984 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6986 yes | yes | yes | yes
6987 Arguments : none
6988
6989 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006990 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006991 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6992 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6993 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6994 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6995
6996 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6997
6998 Example :
6999 option splice-request
7000
7001 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7002 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7003
7004 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7005 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7006
7007
7008option splice-response
7009no option splice-response
7010 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7012 yes | yes | yes | yes
7013 Arguments : none
7014
7015 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007016 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007017 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7018 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7019 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7020 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7021
7022 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7023
7024 Example :
7025 option splice-response
7026
7027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7029
7030 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7031 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7032
7033
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007034option spop-check
7035 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7037 no | no | no | yes
7038 Arguments : none
7039
7040 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7041 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7042 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7043 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7044
7045 Example :
7046 option spop-check
7047
7048 See also : "option httpchk"
7049
7050
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007051option srvtcpka
7052no option srvtcpka
7053 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7055 yes | no | yes | yes
7056 Arguments : none
7057
7058 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7059 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007060 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007061 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7062
7063 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7064 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7065 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7066 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7067
7068 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7069 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7070 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7071 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7072 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7073
7074 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7075
7076 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7077 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7078 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7079
7080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7082
7083 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7084
7085
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007086option ssl-hello-chk
7087 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 yes | no | yes | yes
7090 Arguments : none
7091
7092 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7093 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7094 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7095 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7096 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7097 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7098 hello message.
7099
7100 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7101 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7102 messages, which is appreciable.
7103
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007104 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7105 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7106 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007107
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007108 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7109
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007110
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007111option tcp-check
7112 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7114 yes | no | yes | yes
7115
7116 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7117 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7118
7119 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7120 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7121 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7122
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007123 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007124 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7125 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7126 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7127 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7128 only.
7129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007130 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007131 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7132 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7133 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7134 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7135
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007136 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007137 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7138 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007139 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007140 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7141 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7142 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7143 the respective protocols.
7144 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007145 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007146
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007147 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7148 script.
7149
7150 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7151 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7152 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7153 The "comment" is of course optional.
7154
7155
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007156 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007157 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007158 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007159 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007160
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007161 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007162 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007163 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007164
7165 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7166 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007167 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007168 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007169 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007170 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007171 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007172 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007173 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7174 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007175 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007176 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7177 tcp-check expect string +OK
7178
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007179 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007180 (send many headers before analyzing)
7181 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007182 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007183 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7184 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7185 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7186 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007187 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007188
7189
7190 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7191
7192
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007193option tcp-smart-accept
7194no option tcp-smart-accept
7195 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7197 yes | yes | yes | no
7198 Arguments : none
7199
7200 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7201 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7202 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7203 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7204 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7205 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7206
7207 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7208 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7209 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7210 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7211
7212 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7213 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7214 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007215 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007216
7217 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7218 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7219 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7220
7221 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7222 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7223 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7224
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007225 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7226
7227
7228option tcp-smart-connect
7229no option tcp-smart-connect
7230 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | no | yes | yes
7233 Arguments : none
7234
7235 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7236 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7237 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7238 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7239 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7240
7241 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7242 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7243 complex.
7244
7245 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7246 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7247 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7248
7249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7251
7252 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7253
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007254
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007255option tcpka
7256 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7258 yes | yes | yes | yes
7259 Arguments : none
7260
7261 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7262 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007263 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007264 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7265
7266 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7267 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7268 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7269 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7270
7271 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7272 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7273 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7274 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7275 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7276
7277 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7278
7279 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7280 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7281 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7282 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7283 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7284 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7285 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7286 backends.
7287
7288 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7289
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007290
7291option tcplog
7292 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007294 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007295 Arguments : none
7296
7297 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7298 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7299 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7300 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7301 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7302 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7303 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7304 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7305
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007306 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007308 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007309
7310
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007311option transparent
7312no option transparent
7313 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007315 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007316 Arguments : none
7317
7318 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7319 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7320 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7321 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7322 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7323 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7324 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7325 appropriate server.
7326
7327 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7328 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7329
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007330 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007331 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007332
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007333
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007334external-check command <command>
7335 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | no | yes | yes
7338
7339 Arguments :
7340 <command> is the external command to run
7341
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007342 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7343
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007344 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007345
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007346 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7347 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7348 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7349 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7350 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7351 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007352
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007353 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7354
7355 Environment variables :
7356 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7357 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7358
7359 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7360
7361 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7362
7363 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7364 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7365 for a UNIX socket).
7366
7367 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7368
7369 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7370
7371 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7372
7373 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7374
7375 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7376
7377 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7378 socket).
7379
7380 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7381 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7382
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007383 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7384 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7385 failed.
7386
7387 Example :
7388 external-check command /bin/true
7389
7390 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7391
7392
7393external-check path <path>
7394 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7396 yes | no | yes | yes
7397
7398 Arguments :
7399 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7400
7401 The default path is "".
7402
7403 Example :
7404 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7405
7406 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7407 "external-check command"
7408
7409
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007410persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007411persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007412 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7414 yes | no | yes | yes
7415 Arguments :
7416 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007417 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7418 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007419
7420 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7421 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007422 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007423 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7424 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7425 forwarded to this server.
7426
7427 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7428 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7429 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007430 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007431 a single "listen" section.
7432
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007433 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7434 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7435 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7436
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007437 Example :
7438 listen tse-farm
7439 bind :3389
7440 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7441 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7442 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7443 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7444 persist rdp-cookie
7445 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007446 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007447 balance rdp-cookie
7448 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7449 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7450
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007451 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7452 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007453
7454
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007455rate-limit sessions <rate>
7456 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7458 yes | yes | yes | no
7459 Arguments :
7460 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7461 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7462
7463 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7464 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7465 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7466 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7467 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7468 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7469
7470 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7471 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7472 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7473 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7474
7475 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7476 listen smtp
7477 mode tcp
7478 bind :25
7479 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007480 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007481
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007482 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7483 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7484 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007485
7486 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7487
7488
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007489redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7490redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7491redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007492 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7494 no | yes | yes | yes
7495
7496 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007497 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007498
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007499 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007500 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007501 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7502 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7503 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007504
7505 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7506 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7507 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7508 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7509 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007510 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7511 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7512 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7513 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007514
7515 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7516 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7517 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7518 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7519 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7520 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007521 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007522 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007523 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7524 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7525 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007526
7527 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007528 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7529 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7530 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007531 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007532 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7533 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7534 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7535 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007536
7537 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007538 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007539
7540 - "drop-query"
7541 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7542 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7543 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7544 with a location-type redirect.
7545
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007546 - "append-slash"
7547 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7548 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7549 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7550 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7551
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007552 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7553 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7554 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7555 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7556 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7557 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7558 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7559
7560 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7561 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7562 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7563 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7564 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7565 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7566 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007567
7568 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7569 acl clear dst_port 80
7570 acl secure dst_port 8080
7571 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007572 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007573 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007574 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7575
7576 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007577 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7578 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7579 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007580 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007581
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007582 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7583 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7584 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7585
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007586 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007587 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007588
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007589 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007590 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7591 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7592 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007594 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007595
7596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007597redisp (deprecated)
7598redispatch (deprecated)
7599 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7601 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007602 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007603
7604 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7605 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7606 be able to access the service anymore.
7607
7608 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7609 redistribute them to a working server.
7610
7611 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7612 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7613 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007615 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7616 "option redispatch" instead.
7617
7618 See also : "option redispatch"
7619
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007620
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007621reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007622 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7624 no | yes | yes | yes
7625 Arguments :
7626 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7627 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007628 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007629
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007630 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7631 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7632
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007633 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7634 the last header of an HTTP request.
7635
7636 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7637 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7638 responses.
7639
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007640 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7641 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7642 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7643
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007644 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7645 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007646
7647
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007648reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7649reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007650 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7652 no | yes | yes | yes
7653 Arguments :
7654 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7655 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7656 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7657 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7658 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7659 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7660 ignores case.
7661
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007662 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7663 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7664
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007665 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7666 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7667 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7668 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007669 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007670
7671 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7672 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7673
7674 Example :
7675 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7676 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7677 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7678
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007679 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7680 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007681
7682
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007683reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7684reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007685 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7687 no | yes | yes | yes
7688 Arguments :
7689 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7690 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7691 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7692 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7693 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7694 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7695
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007696 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7697 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7698
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007699 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7700 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7701 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7702 next servers.
7703
7704 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7705 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7706 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7707
7708 Example :
7709 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7710 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7711 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7712
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007713 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7714 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007715
7716
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007717reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7718reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007719 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7721 no | yes | yes | yes
7722 Arguments :
7723 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7724 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7725 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7726 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7727 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7728 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7729 case.
7730
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007731 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7732 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7733
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007734 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7735 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7736 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7737 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007738 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007739
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007740 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007741 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007742 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007743
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007744 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7745 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7746
7747 Example :
7748 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7749 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7750 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7751
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007752 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7753 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007754
7755
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007756reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7757reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007758 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 no | yes | yes | yes
7761 Arguments :
7762 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7763 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7764 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7765 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7766 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7767 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7768 case.
7769
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007770 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7771 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7772
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007773 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7774 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7775 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7776 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7777
7778 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7779 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7780
7781 Example :
7782 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7783 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7784 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7785 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7786
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007787 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7788 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007789
7790
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007791reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7792reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007793 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7795 no | yes | yes | yes
7796 Arguments :
7797 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7798 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7799 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7800 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7801 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7802 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7803
7804 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7805 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7806 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7807 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007808 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007809
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007810 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7811 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7812
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007813 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7814 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7815 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7816
7817 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7818 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7819 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7820 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7821 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7822
7823 Example :
7824 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007825 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007826 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7827 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7828
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007829 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7830 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007831
7832
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007833reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7834reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007835 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7837 no | yes | yes | yes
7838 Arguments :
7839 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7840 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7841 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7842 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7843 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7844 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7845 ignores case.
7846
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007847 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7848 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7849
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007850 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7851 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007852 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7853 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7854 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007855 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7856 not set.
7857
7858 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7859 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7860 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7861 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7862 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7863
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007864 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007865 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007866 # block all others.
7867 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7868 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7869
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007870 # block bad guys
7871 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7872 reqitarpit . if badguys
7873
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007874 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7875 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007876
7877
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007878retries <value>
7879 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7881 yes | no | yes | yes
7882 Arguments :
7883 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7884 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7885 default value is 3.
7886
7887 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7888 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7889 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7890
7891 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007892 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7893 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007894
7895 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7896 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7897
7898 See also : "option redispatch"
7899
7900
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007901rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007902 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7904 no | yes | yes | yes
7905 Arguments :
7906 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7907 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007908 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007909
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007910 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7911 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7912
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007913 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7914 the last header of an HTTP response.
7915
7916 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7917 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7918 responses.
7919
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007920 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7921 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007922
7923
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007924rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7925rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007926 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 no | yes | yes | yes
7929 Arguments :
7930 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7931 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7932 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7933 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7934 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7935 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7936 ignores case.
7937
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007938 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7939 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7940
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007941 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7942 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007943 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007944 client.
7945
7946 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7947 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7948 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7949
7950 Example :
7951 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007952 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007953
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007954 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7955 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007956
7957
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007958rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7959rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007960 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 no | yes | yes | yes
7963 Arguments :
7964 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7965 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7966 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7967 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7968 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7969 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7970 ignores case.
7971
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007972 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7973 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7974
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007975 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7976 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7977 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7978 case-sensitive.
7979
7980 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007981 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7982 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7983 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007984
7985 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7986 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7987
7988 Example :
7989 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7990 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7991
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007992 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7993 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007994
7995
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007996rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7997rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007998 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8000 no | yes | yes | yes
8001 Arguments :
8002 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8003 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8004 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8005 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8006 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8007 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8008 ignores case.
8009
8010 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8011 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8012 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8013 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008014 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008015
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008016 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8017 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8018
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008019 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8020 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8021 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8022
8023 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8024 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8025 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8026 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8027 are not case-sensitive.
8028
8029 Example :
8030 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8031 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8032
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008033 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8034 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008035
8036
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008037server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008038 Declare a server in a backend
8039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8040 no | no | yes | yes
8041 Arguments :
8042 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008043 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008044 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008045
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008046 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8047 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8048 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8049 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008050 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8051 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8052 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8053 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8054 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008055 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8056 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8057 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8058 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8059 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8060 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8061 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008062 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008063 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8064 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8065 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8066 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8067 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8068 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008069 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8070 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008071 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8072 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008073
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008074 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008075 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8076 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8077 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8078 adding this value to the client's port.
8079
8080 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8081 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008082 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008083
8084 Examples :
8085 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8086 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008087 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008088 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8089 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8090 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008091
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008092 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8093 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8094 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8095 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8096 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8097
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008098 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8099 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008100
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008101server-state-file-name [<file>]
8102 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8103 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8104 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8105 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8106 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8107 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8108
8109 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8110 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8111
8112 global
8113 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8114
8115 backend bk
8116 load-server-state-from-file
8117
8118 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8119 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008120
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008121server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8122 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8123 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 no | no | yes | yes
8126
8127 Arguments:
8128 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8129
8130 <num | range>
8131 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8132 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8133 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8134 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8135
8136 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8137
8138 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8139
8140 <params*>
8141 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8142 keyword.
8143
8144 Examples:
8145 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8146 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8147 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8148
8149 # or
8150 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8151
8152 # would be equivalent to:
8153 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8154 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8155 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8156
8157
8158
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008159source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008160source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008161source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008162 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8164 yes | no | yes | yes
8165 Arguments :
8166 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8167 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008168
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008169 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008170 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8171 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8172 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8173 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8174 supported prefixes are :
8175 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8176 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8177 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008178 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008179 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8180 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008181
8182 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8183 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008184 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8185 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8186 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008187
8188 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8189 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8190 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8191 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8192 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8193 <addr>.
8194
8195 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8196 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8197 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8198 port.
8199
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008200 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8201 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8202 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8203 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008204 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008205 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8206 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8207 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8208 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8209 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8210 HTTP header.
8211
8212 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8213 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008214 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008215 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8216 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8217 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8218 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8219 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8220 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8221 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8222
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008223 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8224 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8225 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8226 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8227 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8228 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8229
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008230 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8231 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8232 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8233 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8234
8235 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8236 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8237 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8238 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8239 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8240 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8241
8242 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8243 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8244 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8245 there are two methods :
8246
8247 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8248 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8249 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8250 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8251 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8252 of the client ranges may be used.
8253
8254 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8255 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8256 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8257 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8258 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8259 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8260 same session.
8261
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008262 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8263 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8264 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008265 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008266
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008267 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8268
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008269 Examples :
8270 backend private
8271 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8272 source 192.168.1.200
8273
8274 backend transparent_ssl1
8275 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8276 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8277
8278 backend transparent_ssl2
8279 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8280 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8281 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8282
8283 backend transparent_ssl3
8284 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8285 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8286 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8287
8288 backend transparent_smtp
8289 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8290 # with Tproxy version 4.
8291 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8292
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008293 backend transparent_http
8294 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8295 # proxy.
8296 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008298 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008299 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008301
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008302srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8303 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8305 yes | no | yes | yes
8306 Arguments :
8307 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8308 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8309 as explained at the top of this document.
8310
8311 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8312 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8313 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8314 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8315 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8316 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8317 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8318
8319 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8320 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8321 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8322 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8323 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008324 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008325 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008326 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008327
8328 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8329 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8330 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8331 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8332 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8333 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8334
8335 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8336 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8337
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008338 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8339 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008340
8341
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008342stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8343 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008345 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008346
8347 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8348 matched.
8349
8350 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8351 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8352
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008353 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8354 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008355 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008356
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008357 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8358 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8359 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8360 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008361
8362 Example :
8363 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8364 backend stats_localhost
8365 stats enable
8366 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8367
8368 Example :
8369 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8370 backend stats_auth
8371 stats enable
8372 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8373 stats admin if TRUE
8374
8375 Example :
8376 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8377 userlist stats-auth
8378 group admin users admin
8379 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8380 group readonly users haproxy
8381 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8382
8383 backend stats_auth
8384 stats enable
8385 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8386 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8387 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8388 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8389
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008390 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8391 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8392 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008393
8394
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008395stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8396 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008398 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008399 Arguments :
8400 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8401
8402 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8403
8404 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8405 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8406 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8407 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8408 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8409 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8410
8411 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8412 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8413 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008414 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008415
8416 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8417 report using "stats scope".
8418
8419 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8420 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8421 unobvious parameters.
8422
8423 Example :
8424 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8425 backend public_www
8426 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8427 stats enable
8428 stats hide-version
8429 stats scope .
8430 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008431 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008432 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8433 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8434
8435 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8436 backend private_monitoring
8437 stats enable
8438 stats uri /admin?stats
8439 stats refresh 5s
8440
8441 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8442
8443
8444stats enable
8445 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008448 Arguments : none
8449
8450 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8451 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8452 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8453 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8454 - stats auth : no authentication
8455 - stats scope : no restriction
8456
8457 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8458 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8459 unobvious parameters.
8460
8461 Example :
8462 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8463 backend public_www
8464 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8465 stats enable
8466 stats hide-version
8467 stats scope .
8468 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008469 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008470 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8471 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8472
8473 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8474 backend private_monitoring
8475 stats enable
8476 stats uri /admin?stats
8477 stats refresh 5s
8478
8479 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8480
8481
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008482stats hide-version
8483 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008485 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008486 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008487
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008488 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8489 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8490 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8491 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8492 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8493 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008495 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8496 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8497 unobvious parameters.
8498
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008499 Example :
8500 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8501 backend public_www
8502 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008503 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008504 stats hide-version
8505 stats scope .
8506 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008507 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008508 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8509 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008510
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008511 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8512 backend private_monitoring
8513 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008514 stats uri /admin?stats
8515 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008516
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008517 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008518
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008519
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008520stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8522 Access control for statistics
8523
8524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8525 no | no | yes | yes
8526
8527 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8528 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8529 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8530 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8531 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8532 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8533
8534 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8535 instance.
8536
8537 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8538 about ACL usage.
8539
8540
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008541stats realm <realm>
8542 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008544 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008545 Arguments :
8546 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8547 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8548 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8549
8550 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8551 using a backslash ('\').
8552
8553 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8554 only related to authentication.
8555
8556 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8557 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8558 unobvious parameters.
8559
8560 Example :
8561 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8562 backend public_www
8563 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8564 stats enable
8565 stats hide-version
8566 stats scope .
8567 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008568 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008569 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8570 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8571
8572 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8573 backend private_monitoring
8574 stats enable
8575 stats uri /admin?stats
8576 stats refresh 5s
8577
8578 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8579
8580
8581stats refresh <delay>
8582 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008584 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008585 Arguments :
8586 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8587 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8588 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8589 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8590 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8591 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8592
8593 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8594 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8595 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8596 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8597
8598 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8599 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8600 unobvious parameters.
8601
8602 Example :
8603 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8604 backend public_www
8605 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8606 stats enable
8607 stats hide-version
8608 stats scope .
8609 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008610 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008611 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8612 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8613
8614 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8615 backend private_monitoring
8616 stats enable
8617 stats uri /admin?stats
8618 stats refresh 5s
8619
8620 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8621
8622
8623stats scope { <name> | "." }
8624 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008627 Arguments :
8628 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8629 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8630 section in which the statement appears.
8631
8632 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8633 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8634 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8635 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8636 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8637 exists.
8638
8639 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8640 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8641 unobvious parameters.
8642
8643 Example :
8644 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8645 backend public_www
8646 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8647 stats enable
8648 stats hide-version
8649 stats scope .
8650 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008651 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008652 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8653 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8654
8655 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8656 backend private_monitoring
8657 stats enable
8658 stats uri /admin?stats
8659 stats refresh 5s
8660
8661 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8662
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008663
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008664stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008665 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008667 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008668
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008669 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008670 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8671
8672 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8673 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8674
8675 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8676 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008677 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008678
8679 Example :
8680 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8681 backend private_monitoring
8682 stats enable
8683 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8684 stats uri /admin?stats
8685 stats refresh 5s
8686
8687 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8688 global section.
8689
8690
8691stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008692 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8694 yes | yes | yes | yes
8695 Arguments : none
8696
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008697 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008698 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8699 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8700 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8701 - IP (socket, server)
8702 - cookie (backend, server)
8703
8704 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8705 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008706 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008707
8708 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8709
8710
8711stats show-node [ <name> ]
8712 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008714 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008715 Arguments:
8716 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8717 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8718
8719 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8720 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008721 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008722
8723 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8724 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8725 unobvious parameters.
8726
8727 Example:
8728 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8729 backend private_monitoring
8730 stats enable
8731 stats show-node Europe-1
8732 stats uri /admin?stats
8733 stats refresh 5s
8734
8735 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8736 section.
8737
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008738
8739stats uri <prefix>
8740 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008743 Arguments :
8744 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8745 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8746 query string.
8747
8748 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8749 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8750 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8751 possible to reach it in the application.
8752
8753 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008754 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008755 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8756 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8757 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8758 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8759
8760 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8761 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8762 an address or a port to statistics only.
8763
8764 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8765 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8766 unobvious parameters.
8767
8768 Example :
8769 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8770 backend public_www
8771 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8772 stats enable
8773 stats hide-version
8774 stats scope .
8775 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008776 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008777 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8778 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8779
8780 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8781 backend private_monitoring
8782 stats enable
8783 stats uri /admin?stats
8784 stats refresh 5s
8785
8786 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8787
8788
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008789stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8790 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008792 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008793
8794 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008795 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008796 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008797 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008798 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8799
8800 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8801 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8802 the "stick-table" statement.
8803
8804 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8805 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8806 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8807 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8808 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8809
8810 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8811 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8812 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8813 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8814 transformation rules.
8815
8816 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8817 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8818 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8819 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8820 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8821 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8822 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8823
8824 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8825 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8826 ACL based conditions.
8827
8828 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8829 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8830 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8831 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8832
8833 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8834 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8835 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8836 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8837
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008838 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8839 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008840 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008841
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008842 Example :
8843 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8844 # last 30 minutes
8845 backend pop
8846 mode tcp
8847 balance roundrobin
8848 stick store-request src
8849 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8850 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8851 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8852
8853 backend smtp
8854 mode tcp
8855 balance roundrobin
8856 stick match src table pop
8857 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8858 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8859
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008860 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008861 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008862
8863
8864stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8865 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8867 no | no | yes | yes
8868
8869 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8870 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8871 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8872 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8873
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008874 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8875 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008876 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008877
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008878 Examples :
8879 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008880 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008881
8882 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8883 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8884 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8885
8886
8887 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8888 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8889 backend http
8890 mode http
8891 balance roundrobin
8892 stick on src table https
8893 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8894 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8895 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8896
8897 backend https
8898 mode tcp
8899 balance roundrobin
8900 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8901 stick on src
8902 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8903 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8904
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008905 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008906
8907
8908stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8909 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8911 no | no | yes | yes
8912
8913 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008914 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008915 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008916 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008917 server is selected.
8918
8919 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8920 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8921 the "stick-table" statement.
8922
8923 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8924 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8925 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8926 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8927 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8928 address.
8929
8930 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8931 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8932 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8933 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8934 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8935 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8936 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8937 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8938 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8939 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8940
8941 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8942 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8943 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8944 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8945 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8946 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8947 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8948
8949 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8950 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8951 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8952 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8953
8954 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8955 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8956 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8957 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8958 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8959 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008960 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8961 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8962 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8963 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8964 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8965 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008966
8967 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8968 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8969 the request.
8970
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008971 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8972 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008973 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008974
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008975 Example :
8976 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8977 # last 30 minutes
8978 backend pop
8979 mode tcp
8980 balance roundrobin
8981 stick store-request src
8982 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8983 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8984 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8985
8986 backend smtp
8987 mode tcp
8988 balance roundrobin
8989 stick match src table pop
8990 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8991 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8992
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008993 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008994 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008995
8996
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008997stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008998 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8999 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009000 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009002 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009003
9004 Arguments :
9005 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9006 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9007 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9008 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9009
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009010 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9011 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9012 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9013 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9014
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009015 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9016 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9017 instance.
9018
9019 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9020 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9021 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9022 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9023 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9024 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009025 to 32 characters.
9026
9027 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9028 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9029 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009030 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009031 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9032 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009033
9034 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009035 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9036 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009037 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9038 increase.
9039
9040 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009041 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9042 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9043 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009044
9045 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9046 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9047 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9048 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009049 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009050 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9051 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9052 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9053 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9054 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9055 parameter (see below).
9056
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009057 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9058 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9059 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9060 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9061 soft restart.
9062
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009063 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9064 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009065
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009066 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9067 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9068 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9069 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009070 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009071 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009072 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9073 if not expiration delay is specified.
9074
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009075 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9076 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9077 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9078 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009079 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9080 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9081 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9082 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9083 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9084 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9085 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9086 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9087 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9088 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9089 types and their arguments.
9090
9091 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9092 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9093 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9094 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9095
9096 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9097 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9098 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009099 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009100
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009101 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9102 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9103 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009104 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009105 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009106 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009107
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009108 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9109 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9110 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9111 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9112
9113 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9114 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9115 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9116 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9117 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9118 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9119
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009120 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9121 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9122 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9123 they were received.
9124
9125 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9126 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9127 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9128 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9129 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9130
9131 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9132 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9133 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9134 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9135 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9136
9137 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9138 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9139 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9140
9141 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9142 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9143 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9144 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9145 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9146
9147 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9148 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9149 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9150 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9151 the client side.
9152
9153 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9154 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9155 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9156 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9157 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9158 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9159 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9160
9161 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9162 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9163 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9164 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9165 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9166 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009167 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009168
9169 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9170 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9171 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9172 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9173 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9174 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9175
9176 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009177 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009178 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9179 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9180
9181 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9182 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9183 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9184 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9185 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9186 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9187 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9188 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9189 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9190 recommended for better fairness.
9191
9192 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009193 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009194 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9195 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9196
9197 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9198 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9199 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9200 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9201 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9202 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9203 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9204 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9205 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9206 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009207
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009208 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9209 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009210 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9211 reference it.
9212
9213 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9214 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009215 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9216 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9217 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009218
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009219 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9220 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9221 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9222 something that can be ignored.
9223
9224 Example:
9225 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9226 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9227 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9228 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9229
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009230 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009231 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009232
9233
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009234stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009235 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9237 no | no | yes | yes
9238
9239 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009240 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009241 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009242 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009243 server is selected.
9244
9245 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9246 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9247 the "stick-table" statement.
9248
9249 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9250 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9251 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9252 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9253
9254 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9255 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9256 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9257 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9258 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9259 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009260 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009261 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9262 rules.
9263
9264 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9265 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9266 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9267 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9268 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9269 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9270 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9271
9272 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9273 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9274 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9275 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9276
9277 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9278 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9279 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9280 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9281 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9282 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009283 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9284 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9285 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9286 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9287 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9288 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9289 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9290 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9291 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009292
9293 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9294
9295 Example :
9296 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9297 backend https
9298 mode tcp
9299 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009300 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009301 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009302
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009303 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9304 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9305
9306 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9307 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9308 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9309
9310 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9311 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009312
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009313 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9314 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9315 # at offset 44.
9316
9317 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9318 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9319
9320 # Learn on response if server hello.
9321 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009322
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009323 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9324 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9325
9326 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9327 extraction.
9328
9329
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009330tcp-check connect [params*]
9331 Opens a new connection
9332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9333 no | no | yes | yes
9334
9335 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9336 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9337 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9338
9339 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9340 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9341 of the sequence.
9342
9343 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9344 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9345 do.
9346
9347 Parameters :
9348 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9349 use the TCP connection.
9350
9351 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9352 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9353 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9354
9355 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9356
9357 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9358
9359 Examples:
9360 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9361 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9362 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9363 option tcp-check
9364 tcp-check connect
9365 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9366 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9367 tcp-check send \r\n
9368 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9369 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9370 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9371 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9372 tcp-check send \r\n
9373 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9374 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9375
9376 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9377 option tcp-check
9378 tcp-check connect port 110
9379 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9380 tcp-check connect port 143
9381 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9382 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9383
9384 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9385
9386
9387tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009388 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 no | no | yes | yes
9391
9392 Arguments :
9393 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9394 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9395 binary.
9396 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9397 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9398 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9399
9400 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9401 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9402 with the usual backslash ('\').
9403 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009404 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009405 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9406 used upper or lower case.
9407
9408
9409 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9410
9411 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9412 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9413 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9414 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9415 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9416 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9417 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9418 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9419
9420 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9421 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9422 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9423 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9424 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9425 expression.
9426
9427 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9428 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9429 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9430 this exact hexadecimal string.
9431 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9432
9433 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9434 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9435 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9436 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9437 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9438 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9439 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9440 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9441 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9442 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9443 the null character.
9444
9445 Examples :
9446 # perform a POP check
9447 option tcp-check
9448 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9449
9450 # perform an IMAP check
9451 option tcp-check
9452 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9453
9454 # look for the redis master server
9455 option tcp-check
9456 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009457 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009458 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9459 tcp-check expect string role:master
9460 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9461 tcp-check expect string +OK
9462
9463
9464 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9465 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9466
9467
9468tcp-check send <data>
9469 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9471 no | no | yes | yes
9472
9473 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9474 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9475
9476 Examples :
9477 # look for the redis master server
9478 option tcp-check
9479 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9480 tcp-check expect string role:master
9481
9482 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9483 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9484
9485
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009486tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9487 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009488 tcp health check
9489 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9490 no | no | yes | yes
9491
9492 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9493 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009494 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009495 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9496 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9497 hexadecimal string.
9498 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9499
9500 Examples :
9501 # redis check in binary
9502 option tcp-check
9503 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9504 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9505
9506
9507 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9508 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9509
9510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009511tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9512 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9514 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009515 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009516 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9517 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009519 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009520
9521 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9522 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009523 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9524 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9525 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9526 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9527 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9528 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009529
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009530 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9531 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9532 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9533 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009534
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009535 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009536 - accept :
9537 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9538 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9539 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009540
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009541 - reject :
9542 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9543 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9544 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9545 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9546 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9547 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9548 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9549 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9550 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9551 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9552 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009553 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009554
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009555 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9556 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9557 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9558 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9559 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9560 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9561 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9562 hosts.
9563
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009564 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9565 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9566 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9567 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9568 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9569 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9570 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9571 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9572
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009573 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9574 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9575 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9576 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9577 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9578 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9579 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9580 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9581 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009582 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9583 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009584
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009585 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009586 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009587 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9588 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9589 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9590 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9591 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9592 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9593 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9594 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9595 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9596 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9597 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9598 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009600 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009601 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009602 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009603 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009604 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9605 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9606 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009607
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009608 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9609 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9610 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9611 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009613 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9614 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9615 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9616 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9617 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009618 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9619 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9620 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9621 layer7 information is extracted.
9622
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009623 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9624 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9625 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9626 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9627 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009628
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009629 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9630 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9631 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9632 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9633
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009634 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9635 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9636 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9637 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9638
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009639 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9640 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9641 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9642 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9643 continues.
9644
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009645 - set-src <expr> :
9646 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9647 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9648 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009649 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009650
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009651 Arguments:
9652 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9653 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009654
9655 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009656 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9657
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009658 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9659 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009660
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009661 - set-src-port <expr> :
9662 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9663 expression.
9664
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009665 Arguments:
9666 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9667 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009668
9669 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009670 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9671
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009672 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9673 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9674 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009675
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009676 - set-dst <expr> :
9677 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9678 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9679 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9680 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9681 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9682
9683 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9684 followed by some converters.
9685
9686 Example:
9687
9688 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9689 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9690
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009691 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9692 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9693
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009694 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9695 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9696 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9697 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9698
9699
9700 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9701 followed by some converters.
9702
9703 Example:
9704
9705 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9706
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009707 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9708 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9709 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9710
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009711 - "silent-drop" :
9712 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009713 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009714 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9715 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9716 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9717 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9718 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009719 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9720 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009721 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9722 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009723 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009724 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9725 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9726 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9727 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009729 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9730 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9731 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009732
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009733 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9734 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9735 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009736
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009737 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009738 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009739 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009740
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009741 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9742 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9743 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009744
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009745 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009746 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9747 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009748
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009749 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9750
9751 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9752
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009753 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9754
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009755 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009756
9757
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009758tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9759 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009761 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009762 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009763 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9764 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009765
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009766 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009767
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009768 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009769 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9770 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9771 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9772 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009773
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009774 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9775 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9776 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9777 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009778 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9779 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9780 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9781 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9782 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9783 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009784 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009785 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9788 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9789 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9790 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009791
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009792 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009793 - accept : the request is accepted
9794 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9795 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009796 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009797 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009798 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009799 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009800 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009801 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009802 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009803 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009804 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009805
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009806 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9807 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009808
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009809 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9810 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9811 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9812 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9813 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9814 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009816 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009817 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9818 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009819
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009820 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009821 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9822 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9823 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9824 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009825 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9826 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9827 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009828
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009829 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009830 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9831 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9832 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009833
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009834 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009835 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9836 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009837
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009838 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9839 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009840 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009841 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9842 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009843 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009844 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009845 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009846 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9847 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009848 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009849 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9850 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009851
9852 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9853 followed by some converters.
9854
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009855 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9856 <var-name>.
9857
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009858 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9859 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9860 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9861 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9862 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9863
9864 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9865 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9866 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9867 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9868 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9869 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9870 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9871 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9872 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9873 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9874 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9875
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009876 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9877 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9878 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9879 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9880 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9881
9882 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9883
9884 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9885
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009886 Example:
9887
9888 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009889 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009890
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009891 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009892 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9893 # and reject everything else.
9894 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9895 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009896 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009897 tcp-request content reject
9898
9899 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009900 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9901 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9902 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009903 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009904
9905 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9906 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9907 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009908 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009909 tcp-request content reject
9910
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009911 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009912 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009913 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009914 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009915 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9916 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009917
9918 Example:
9919 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9920 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009921 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009922
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009923 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009924 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009925
9926 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009927 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009928 # protecting all our sites
9929 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009930 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9931 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009932 ...
9933 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9934
9935 backend http_dynamic
9936 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009937 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009938 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009939 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009940 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009941 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009942 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009944 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009945
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009946 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9947 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009948
9949
9950tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9951 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009953 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009954 Arguments :
9955 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9956 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9957 as explained at the top of this document.
9958
9959 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9960 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9961 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9962 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9963 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9964
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009965 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9966 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9967 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9968 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9969
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009970 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9971 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009972 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009973 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009974 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9975 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9976 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9977 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009978
9979 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9980 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9981 it pass through unaffected.
9982
9983 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9984 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9985 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009986 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009987 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9988 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009989 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9990 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9991 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009992
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009993 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009994 "timeout client".
9995
9996
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009997tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9998 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10000 no | no | yes | yes
10001 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010002 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10003 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010004
10005 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10006
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010007 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010008 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10009 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010010 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10011 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010012
10013 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10014
10015 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10016 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10017 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10018 inserted.
10019
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010020 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010021 - accept :
10022 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10023 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10024 the rules evaluation.
10025
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010026 - close :
10027 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10028 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10029 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10030 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10031 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10032 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010033 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010034 protocols.
10035
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010036 - reject :
10037 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10038 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010039 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010040
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010041 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10042 Sets a variable.
10043
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010044 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10045 Unsets a variable.
10046
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010047 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10048 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10049 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10050 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10051
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010052 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10053 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10054 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10055 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10056
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010057 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10058 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10059 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10060 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10061 continues.
10062
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010063 - "silent-drop" :
10064 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010065 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010066 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10067 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10068 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10069 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10070 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010071 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10072 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010073 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10074 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010075 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010076 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10077 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10078 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10079 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10080
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010081 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10082 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10083
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010084 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10085 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10086 for changing the default action to a reject.
10087
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010088 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10089 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10090 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10091 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010092 period.
10093
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010094 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10095 declared inline.
10096
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010097 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10098 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010099 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010100 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10101 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010102 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010103 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010104 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010105 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10106 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010107 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010108 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10109 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010110
10111 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10112 followed by some converters.
10113
10114 Example:
10115
10116 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10117
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010118 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10119 <var-name>.
10120
10121 Example:
10122
10123 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10124
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010125 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10126 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10127 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10128 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10129 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10130
10131 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10132
10133 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10134
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010135 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10136
10137 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10138
10139
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010140tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10141 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10143 no | yes | yes | no
10144 Arguments :
10145 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10146 below.
10147
10148 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10149
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010150 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010151 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10152 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10153 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10154 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10155 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10156 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10157 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010158 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010159 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10160 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10161 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10162 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10163 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10164 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10165 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10166 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10167 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10168 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10169 instead.
10170
10171 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10172 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10173 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10174 rules which may be inserted.
10175
10176 Several types of actions are supported :
10177 - accept : the request is accepted
10178 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10179 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10180 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010181 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010182 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10183 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010184 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010185 - silent-drop
10186
10187 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10188 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10189 sections for a complete description.
10190
10191 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10192 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10193 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10194
10195 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10196 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10197 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10198 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10199 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10200
10201 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10202 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10203
10204 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10205 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10206 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10207
10208 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10209 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10210 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10211
10212 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10213 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10214 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10215
10216 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10217 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10218 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10219
10220 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10221
10222 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10223
10224
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010225tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10226 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10228 no | no | yes | yes
10229 Arguments :
10230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10232 as explained at the top of this document.
10233
10234 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10235
10236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010237timeout check <timeout>
10238 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10239 established.
10240
10241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10242 yes | no | yes | yes
10243 Arguments:
10244 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10245 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10246 as explained at the top of this document.
10247
10248 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10249 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010250 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010251 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010252 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10253 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10254 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010255
10256 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10257 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10258
10259 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10260 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010261 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010262
10263 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10264 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10265 forget about it.
10266
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010267 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10268 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010269
10270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010271timeout client <timeout>
10272timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10273 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10275 yes | yes | yes | no
10276 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010277 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010278 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10279 as explained at the top of this document.
10280
10281 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10282 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10283 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010284 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10285 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10286 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10287 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010288 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10289 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10290 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010291 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010292 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010293 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10294 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010295 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10296 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010297
10298 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10299 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10300 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10301 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10302 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10303 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10304
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010305 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010307 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10308 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10309 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10310
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010311 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10312 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010313
10314
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010315timeout client-fin <timeout>
10316 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10318 yes | yes | yes | no
10319 Arguments :
10320 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10322 as explained at the top of this document.
10323
10324 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10325 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10326 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10327 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10328 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10329 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10330 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010331 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10332 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10333 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010334
10335 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10336 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10337 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10338
10339 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10340
10341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010342timeout connect <timeout>
10343timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10344 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10346 yes | no | yes | yes
10347 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010348 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010349 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10350 as explained at the top of this document.
10351
10352 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010353 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010354 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010355 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010356 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10357 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010358
10359 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10360 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10361 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10362 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10363 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10364 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10365
10366 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10367 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10368 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10369
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010370 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10371 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010372
10373
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010374timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10375 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10377 yes | yes | yes | yes
10378 Arguments :
10379 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10380 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10381 as explained at the top of this document.
10382
10383 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10384 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10385 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10386 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10387 once the request has started to present itself.
10388
10389 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10390 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10391 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10392 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10393 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10394
10395 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10396 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10397 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10398 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10399
10400 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10401 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010402 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010403 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10404 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010405 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010406
10407 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10408 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10409 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10410 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10411
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010412 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10413 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010414 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10415
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010416 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10417
10418
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010419timeout http-request <timeout>
10420 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010422 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010423 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010424 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010425 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10426 as explained at the top of this document.
10427
10428 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10429 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10430 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10431 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10432 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10433 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10434 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010435 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10436 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10437 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10438 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010439 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010440 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10441 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010442
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010443 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10444 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10445 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10446 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10447 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010448 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010449
10450 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10451 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010452 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010453 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10454 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10455
10456 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010457 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10458 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10459 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010460
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010461 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010462 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010463
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010464
10465timeout queue <timeout>
10466 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10468 yes | no | yes | yes
10469 Arguments :
10470 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10471 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10472 as explained at the top of this document.
10473
10474 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10475 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10476 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10477 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10478 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10479
10480 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10481 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10482 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10483 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10484
10485 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10486
10487
10488timeout server <timeout>
10489timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10490 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10492 yes | no | yes | yes
10493 Arguments :
10494 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10495 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10496 as explained at the top of this document.
10497
10498 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10499 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10500 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10501 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10502 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10503 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10504 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10505
10506 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10507 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10508 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10509 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10510 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010511 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010512 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010513 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10514 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010515 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10516 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010517
10518 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10519 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10520 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10521 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10522 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10523 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10524
10525 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10526 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10527 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10528
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010529 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010530
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010531
10532timeout server-fin <timeout>
10533 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10535 yes | no | yes | yes
10536 Arguments :
10537 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10538 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10539 as explained at the top of this document.
10540
10541 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10542 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10543 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10544 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10545 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10546 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10547 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10548 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10549 situations, it should not be needed.
10550
10551 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10552 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10553 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10554
10555 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10556
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010557
10558timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010559 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10561 yes | yes | yes | yes
10562 Arguments :
10563 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10564 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10565 as explained at the top of this document.
10566
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010567 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10568 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10569 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10570 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010571
10572 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10573 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10574 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10575 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010576 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010577
10578 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10579
10580
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010581timeout tunnel <timeout>
10582 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10584 yes | no | yes | yes
10585 Arguments :
10586 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10587 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10588 as explained at the top of this document.
10589
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010590 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010591 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10592 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10593 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010594 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10595 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010596 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10597 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10598 specified.
10599
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010600 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10601 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10602 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10603 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10604 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10605 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10606 state.
10607
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010608 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10609 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10610 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10611 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010612 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010613
10614 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10615 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10616 forget about it.
10617
10618 Example :
10619 defaults http
10620 option http-server-close
10621 timeout connect 5s
10622 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010623 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010624 timeout server 30s
10625 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10626
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010627 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010628
10629
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010630transparent (deprecated)
10631 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010633 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010634 Arguments : none
10635
10636 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10637 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10638 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10639 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10640 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10641 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10642 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10643 appropriate server.
10644
10645 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10646
10647 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10648 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10649
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010650 See also: "option transparent"
10651
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010652unique-id-format <string>
10653 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10655 yes | yes | yes | no
10656 Arguments :
10657 <string> is a log-format string.
10658
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010659 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10660 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10661 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10662 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010663
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010664 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10665 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10666 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10667 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10668 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10669 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10670 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10671 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010672
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010673 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10674 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010675
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010676 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010677
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010678 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010679
10680 will generate:
10681
10682 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10683
10684 See also: "unique-id-header"
10685
10686unique-id-header <name>
10687 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10689 yes | yes | yes | no
10690 Arguments :
10691 <name> is the name of the header.
10692
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010693 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10694 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010695
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010696 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010697
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010698 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010699 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10700
10701 will generate:
10702
10703 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10704
10705 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010706
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010707use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010708 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10710 no | yes | yes | no
10711 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010712 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10713 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010714
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010715 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10716 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010717
10718 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10719 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10720 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010721 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010722 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010723 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10724 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010725
10726 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10727 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10728 assign the backend.
10729
10730 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10731 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10732 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10733 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10734 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10735 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10736
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010737 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010738 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010739 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10740 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10741 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10742
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010743 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10744 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10745 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10746 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10747 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10748 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10749 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10750 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10751 cannot be forced from the request.
10752
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010753 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010754 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10755 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10756
10757 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10758 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010759
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010760
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010761use-server <server> if <condition>
10762use-server <server> unless <condition>
10763 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10765 no | no | yes | yes
10766 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010767 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010768
10769 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10770
10771 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10772 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10773 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10774
10775 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10776 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10777 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10778 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10779 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10780 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10781 matches will assign the server.
10782
10783 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10784 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10785 with the next rules until one matches.
10786
10787 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10788 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10789 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10790 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10791
10792 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10793 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10794 stripped.
10795
10796 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10797 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10798 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10799 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10800
10801 Example :
10802 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10803 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10804 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10805 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10806 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10807 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010808 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010809 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10810 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10811
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010812 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010813
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010814
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108155. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010816--------------------------
10817
10818The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10819depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10820settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10821written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10822described in this section.
10823
10824
108255.1. Bind options
10826-----------------
10827
10828The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10829as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10830no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10831parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10832while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10833provided immediately after the setting name.
10834
10835The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10836
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010837accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10838 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10839 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10840 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10841 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10842 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10843 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10844 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10845 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10846 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010847 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10848 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10849 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010850
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010851accept-proxy
10852 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010853 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10854 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010855 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10856 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10857 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10858 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010859 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010860 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10861 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010862 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10863 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010864
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010865allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010866 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010867 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10868 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10869 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10870 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010871
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010872alpn <protocols>
10873 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10874 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10875 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10876 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10877 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010878 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10879 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10880 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10881 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10882 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10883 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10884 preference, like below :
10885
10886 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010887
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010888backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010889 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010890 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10891
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010892curves <curves>
10893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10894 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10895 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10896 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10897 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10898 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10899
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010900ecdhe <named curve>
10901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010902 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10903 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010904
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010905ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10907 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10908 client's certificate.
10909
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010910ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10912 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10913 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10914 error is ignored.
10915
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010916ca-sign-file <cafile>
10917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10918 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10919 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10920 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10921 'generate-certificates' for details.
10922
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010923ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10925 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10926 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10927 'generate-certificates' for details.
10928
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010929ciphers <ciphers>
10930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10931 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010932 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010933 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010934 information and recommendations see e.g.
10935 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10936 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10937 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10938
10939ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10941 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10942 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10943 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010944 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10945 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010946
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010947crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10949 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10950 to verify client's certificate.
10951
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010952crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010953 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10954 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10955 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10956 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10957 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10958 file.
10959
10960 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10961 are loaded.
10962
10963 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010964 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010965 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10966 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10967 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10968 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010969 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10970 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010971 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010972
10973 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10974 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10975 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10976 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010977 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10978 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010979
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010980 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010981
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010982 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010983 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010984 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10985 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010986 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10987 clients).
10988
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010989 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10990 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10991 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10992 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10993 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10994 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10995 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10996 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10997 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10998 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10999 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11000 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11001 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11002
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011003 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11004 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11005 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11006 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11007 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11008
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011009 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11010 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11011 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11012 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011013
11014 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11015 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11016 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11017 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11018 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11019 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11020 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11021 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11022 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11023
11024 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11025
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011026 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011027 a cert bundle.
11028
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011030 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11031 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11032 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11033 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11034 provide multi-cert support.
11035
11036 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11037
11038 Filename | CN | SAN
11039 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11040 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011041 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011042 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11043 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11044
11045 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11046 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11047 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11048 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011049 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11050 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11051 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011052
11053 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11054 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11055
11056 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11057 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11058 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11059
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011060crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011062 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011063 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011064 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011065
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011066crt-list <file>
11067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011068 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11069 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011070
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011071 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11072
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011073 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11074 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011075 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011076 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011077
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011078 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11079 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11080 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11081 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11082 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11083 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11084 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11085 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011086
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011087 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011088 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011089 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11090 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11091 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011092
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011093 crt-list file example:
11094 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011095 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011096 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011097 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011098
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011099defer-accept
11100 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11101 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11102 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011103 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011104 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11105 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11106 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11107 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11108 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11109 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11110 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11111
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011112expose-fd listeners
11113 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11114 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011115 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11116 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011117 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011118
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011119force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011120 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011121 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011122 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011123 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011124
11125force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011126 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011127 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011128 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011129
11130force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011131 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011132 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011133 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011134
11135force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011136 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011137 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011138 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011139
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011140force-tlsv13
11141 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11142 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011143 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011144
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011145generate-certificates
11146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11147 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11148 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11149 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11150 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11151 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11152 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11153 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11154 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11155 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11156 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11157
11158 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11159 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011160 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011161 certificate is used many times.
11162
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011163gid <gid>
11164 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11165 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11166 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11167 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11168 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11169
11170group <group>
11171 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11172 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11173 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11174 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11175 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11176
11177id <id>
11178 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11179 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11180 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11181 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11182
11183interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011184 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11185 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11186 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11187 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11188 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11189 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011190 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11191 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11192 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11193 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11194 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11195 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011196
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011197level <level>
11198 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11199 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11200 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011201 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011202 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11203 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11204 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011205 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011206 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011207 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011208 all counters).
11209
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011210severity-output <format>
11211 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11212 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11213 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11214 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11215 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11216 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11217 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11218 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11219 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11220 rfc5424 convention.
11221
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011222maxconn <maxconn>
11223 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11224 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11225 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11226 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11227 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11228 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11229 eat all memory.
11230
11231mode <mode>
11232 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11233 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11234 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11235 UNIX sockets.
11236
11237mss <maxseg>
11238 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11239 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11240 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11241 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11242 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11243 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11244 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11245 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11246 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11247 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11248 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11249
11250name <name>
11251 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11252 page.
11253
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011254namespace <name>
11255 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11256 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11257 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11258 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11259
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011260nice <nice>
11261 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11262 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11263 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11264 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11265 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11266 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11267 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11268 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11269 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11270 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11271 one for an RDP socket.
11272
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011273no-ca-names
11274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11275 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11276
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011277no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011279 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011280 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011281 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011282 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11283 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011284
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011285no-tls-tickets
11286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11287 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11288 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011289 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11290 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011291
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011292no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011294 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011295 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011296 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011297 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11298 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011299
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011300no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011302 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011303 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011304 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011305 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11306 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011307
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011308no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011310 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011311 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011312 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011313 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11314 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011315
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011316no-tlsv13
11317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11318 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11319 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11320 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011321 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11322 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011323
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011324npn <protocols>
11325 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11326 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11327 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11328 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011329 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011330 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11331 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11332 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11333 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11334 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011335
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011336prefer-client-ciphers
11337 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11338 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11339 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011340 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11341 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11342 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011343
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011344process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011345 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011346 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011347 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011348 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11349 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11350 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11351 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011352 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011353 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11354 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11355 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11356 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11357 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011358
11359 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11360
11361 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11362 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11363 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11364 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11365 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11366 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11367 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11368 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011369
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011370proto <name>
11371 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11372 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11373 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11374 in haproxy -vv.
11375 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11376 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011377 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011378 h2" on the bind line.
11379
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011380ssl
11381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011382 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011383 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11384 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011385 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11386 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011387
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011388ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11389 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11390 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11391 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11392
11393ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11394 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11395 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11396 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11397
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011398strict-sni
11399 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11400 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11401 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11402 See the "crt" option for more information.
11403
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011404tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011405 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011406 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11407 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011408 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011409 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11410 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11411 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11412 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11413 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11414 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11415 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11416
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011417tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011418 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011419 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11420 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11421 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11422 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11423 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11424 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11425 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011426 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11427 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11428 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011429
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011430tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11431 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011432 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11433 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11434 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11435 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11436 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11437 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11438 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11439 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11440 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11441 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011442 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11443 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11444
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011445transparent
11446 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11447 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11448 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11449 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11450 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11451 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11452 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11453 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11454 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11455 so check for support with your vendor.
11456
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011457v4v6
11458 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11459 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11460 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11461 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011462 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011463
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011464v6only
11465 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11466 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11467 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011468 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11469 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011470
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011471uid <uid>
11472 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11473 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11474 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11475 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11476 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11477
11478user <user>
11479 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11480 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11481 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11482 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11483 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11484
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011485verify [none|optional|required]
11486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11487 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11488 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11489 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11490 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011491 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11492 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11493 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11494 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011495
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114965.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011497------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011499The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11500which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11501arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11502settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11503after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11504Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11505address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011507 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011508 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011509
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011510Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11511keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011513The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011514
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011515addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011516 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011517 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11518 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11519 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11520 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11521 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011522
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011523agent-check
11524 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011525 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011526 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11527 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11528 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011529
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011530 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011531 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011532 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11533 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11534 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011535
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011536 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11537 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11538 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11539 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11540 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011541
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011542 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011543 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011544
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011545 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11546 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11547 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011548
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011549 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11550 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11551 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011552
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011553 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11554 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11555 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11556 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11557 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011559 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011560
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011561 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11562 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011563
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011564 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11565 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11566 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11567 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11568 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11569 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11570 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11571 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11572 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011573
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011574 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11575 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011576 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11577 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11578 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011579 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011580
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011581 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011582 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011583
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011584agent-send <string>
11585 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11586 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11587 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11588 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11589 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11590
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011591agent-inter <delay>
11592 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11593 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11594
11595 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11596 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11597 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11598 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11599 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11600 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11601 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11602 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11603 of backends use the same servers.
11604
11605 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11606
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011607agent-addr <addr>
11608 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11609
11610 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11611 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11612 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11613 hostname, it will be resolved.
11614
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011615agent-port <port>
11616 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11617
11618 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11619
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011620alpn <protocols>
11621 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11622 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11623 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11624 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11625 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11626 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11627 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11628 now obsolete NPN extension.
11629 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11630 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11631
11632 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011634backup
11635 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11636 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11637 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11638 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011639 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11640 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011641
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011642ca-file <cafile>
11643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11644 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11645 server's certificate.
11646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011647check
11648 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011649 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11650 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11651 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11652 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11653 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11654 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11655 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011656 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11657 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011658 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11659 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011660
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011661check-send-proxy
11662 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11663 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11664 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11665 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11666 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11667 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11668 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11669
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011670check-alpn <protocols>
11671 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11672 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11673 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11674
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011675check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011676 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011677 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11678 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011679
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011680check-ssl
11681 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11682 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11683 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11684 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011685 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011686 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11687 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011688 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011689 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11690 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011691
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011692ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11694 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11695 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011696 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11697 information and recommendations see e.g.
11698 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11699 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11700 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011701
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011702ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11704 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11705 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11706 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011707 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11708 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11709 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011711cookie <value>
11712 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11713 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11714 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11715 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11716 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11717 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11718 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11719
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011720crl-file <crlfile>
11721 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11722 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11723 to verify server's certificate.
11724
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011725crt <cert>
11726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11727 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11728 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11729 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11730 certificate request.
11731
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011732disabled
11733 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11734 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11735 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11736 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11737 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011738 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011739
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011740enabled
11741 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11742 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11743 default value.
11744 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11745 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011747error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011748 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11749 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11750 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011752 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011754fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011755 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11756 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11757 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11758
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011759force-sslv3
11760 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11761 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011762 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011763 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011764
11765force-tlsv10
11766 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011767 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011768 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011769
11770force-tlsv11
11771 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011772 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011773 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011774
11775force-tlsv12
11776 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011777 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011778 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011779
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011780force-tlsv13
11781 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11782 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011783 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011785id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011786 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11787 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11788 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011789
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011790init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11791 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11792 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011793 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011794 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11795 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11796 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11797 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11798 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11799 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11800 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11801 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11802 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011803 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011804 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11805 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11806 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11807 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11808 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11809 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011810 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011811
11812 Example:
11813 defaults
11814 # never fail on address resolution
11815 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011817inter <delay>
11818fastinter <delay>
11819downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011820 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11821 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11822 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11823 between checks depending on the server state :
11824
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011825 Server state | Interval used
11826 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11827 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11828 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11829 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11830 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11831 or yet unchecked. |
11832 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11833 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11834 | "inter" otherwise.
11835 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011837 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11838 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11839 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11840 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011841 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11842 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11843 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11844 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11845 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011847maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011848 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11849 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11850 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11851 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11852 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11853 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11854 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11855 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011857maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011858 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11859 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11860 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11861 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11862 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11863 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11864 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11865
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011866max-reuse <count>
11867 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11868 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11869 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11870 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11871 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11872 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11873 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11874 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011876minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011877 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11878 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11879 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11880 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11881 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11882 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011883 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011884 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011885
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011886namespace <name>
11887 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11888 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11889 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11890 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11891
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011892no-agent-check
11893 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11894 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11895 default value.
11896 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11897 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11898
11899no-backup
11900 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11901 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11902 default value.
11903 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11904 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11905
11906no-check
11907 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11908 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11909 default value.
11910 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11911 "default-server" "check" setting.
11912
11913no-check-ssl
11914 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11915 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11916 default value.
11917 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11918 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11919
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011920no-send-proxy
11921 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11922 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11923 default value.
11924 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11925 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11926
11927no-send-proxy-v2
11928 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11929 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11930 default value.
11931 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11932 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11933
11934no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11935 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11936 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11937 default value.
11938 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11939 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11940
11941no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11942 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11943 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11944 default value.
11945 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11946 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11947
11948no-ssl
11949 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11950 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11951 default value.
11952 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11953 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11954
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011955no-ssl-reuse
11956 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11957 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11958 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11959 and for paranoid users.
11960
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011961no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011962 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11963 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011964 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011965
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011966 Supported in default-server: No
11967
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011968no-tls-tickets
11969 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11970 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11971 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011972 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11973 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011974 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011975
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011976no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011977 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011978 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11979 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011980 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11981 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011982 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011983
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011984 Supported in default-server: No
11985
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011986no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011987 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011988 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11989 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011990 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11991 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011992 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011993
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011994 Supported in default-server: No
11995
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011996no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011997 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011998 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11999 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012000 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12001 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012002 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012003
12004 Supported in default-server: No
12005
12006no-tlsv13
12007 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12008 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12009 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12010 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12011 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012012 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012013
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012014 Supported in default-server: No
12015
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012016no-verifyhost
12017 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12018 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12019 default value.
12020 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12021 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012022
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012023non-stick
12024 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12025 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12026 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12027
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012028npn <protocols>
12029 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12030 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12031 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12032 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12033 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12034 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12035 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012037observe <mode>
12038 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12039 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12040 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12041 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12042 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12043 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012044 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012045
12046 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012048on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012049 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12050 Currently, four modes are available:
12051 - fastinter: force fastinter
12052 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12053 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12054 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12055 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12056
12057 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12058
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012059on-marked-down <action>
12060 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12061 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012062 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12063 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12064 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12065 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12066 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12067 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12068 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12069 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012070
12071 Actions are disabled by default
12072
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012073on-marked-up <action>
12074 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12075 Currently one action is available:
12076 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12077 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12078 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12079 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012080 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12081 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012082 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12083 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12084
12085 Actions are disabled by default
12086
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012087pool-max-conn <max>
12088 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12089 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12090 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12091 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12092 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12093 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12094
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012095pool-purge-delay <delay>
12096 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12097 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12098 1s.
12099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012100port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012101 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12102 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12103 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12104 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12105 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12106 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12107
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012108proto <name>
12109
12110 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12111 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12112 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12113 reported in haproxy -vv.
12114 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12115 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012117redir <prefix>
12118 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12119 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12120 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12121 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12122 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12123 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12124 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12125 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012126 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012127 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012128 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12129 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12130 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12131 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12132
12133 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012135rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012136 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12137 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12138 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12139
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012140resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12141 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12142 server.
12143
12144 Available options:
12145
12146 * allow-dup-ip
12147 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12148 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12149 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12150 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12151 For such case, simply enable this option.
12152 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12153
12154 * prevent-dup-ip
12155 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12156 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12157 same fqdn.
12158 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12159
12160 Example:
12161 backend b_myapp
12162 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12163 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12164 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12165
12166 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12167 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12168 it
12169 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12170 different address
12171
12172 Default value: not set
12173
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012174resolve-prefer <family>
12175 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12176 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12177 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12178 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12179
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012180 Default value: ipv6
12181
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012182 Example:
12183
12184 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012185
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012186resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12187 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12188 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012189 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012190 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12191 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012192 configured network, another address is selected.
12193
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012194 Example:
12195
12196 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012197
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012198resolvers <id>
12199 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12200 hostname.
12201
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012202 Example:
12203
12204 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012205
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012206 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012207
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012208send-proxy
12209 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12210 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12211 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12212 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012213 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12214 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12215 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12216 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12217 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12218 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12219 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12220 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12221 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12222 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012223 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12224 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012225
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012226send-proxy-v2
12227 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12228 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12229 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12230 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012231 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12232 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12233 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12234 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012235
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012236proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12237 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12238 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012239 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12240 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012241 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12242 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012243 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012244
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012245send-proxy-v2-ssl
12246 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12247 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12248 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12249 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12250 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12251 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12252 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012253 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12254 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012255
12256send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12257 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12258 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12259 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12260 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12261 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12262 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12263 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12264 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012265 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12266 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012268slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012269 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12270 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12271 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12272 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12273 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12274 parameters :
12275
12276 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12277 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12278
12279 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12280 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12281 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12282 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12283
12284 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12285 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12286 seen as failed.
12287
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012288sni <expression>
12289 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12290 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12291 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12292 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012293 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12294 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012295 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012296 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12297 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012298
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012299source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012300source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012301source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012302 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12303 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12304 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12305 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12306
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012307 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12308 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12309 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12310 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12311 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12312 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12313 server.
12314
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012315 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12316 specifying the source address without port(s).
12317
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012318ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012319 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12320 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12321 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12322 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12323 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12324 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012325 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12326 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012327
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012328ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12329 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12330 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12331 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12332
12333ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12334 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12335 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12336 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12337
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012338ssl-reuse
12339 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12340 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12341 default value.
12342 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12343 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12344
12345stick
12346 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12347 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12348 default value.
12349 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12350 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012351
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012352tcp-ut <delay>
12353 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12354 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12355 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012356 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012357 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12358 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12359 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12360 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12361 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12362 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12363 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12364 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12365 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012367track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012368 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12369 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12370 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12371 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012372 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12373
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012374tls-tickets
12375 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12376 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12377 default value.
12378 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12379 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012380
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012381verify [none|required]
12382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012383 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012384 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12385 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012386 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012387 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12388 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12389 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12390 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12391 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12392 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12393 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12394 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012395
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012396verifyhost <hostname>
12397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012398 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12399 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12400 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12401 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12402 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12403 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12404 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12405 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012407weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012408 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12409 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12410 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012411 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12412 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12413 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12414 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12415 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12416 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012417
12418
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124195.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12420-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012421
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012422HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12423using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12424configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012425This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12426can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12427workload.
12428This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12429resolution at run time.
12430Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12431carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12432
12433
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124345.3.1. Global overview
12435----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012436
12437As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12438different steps of the process life:
12439
12440 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12441 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12442 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12443
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012444 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12445 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012446
12447A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12448 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12449 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12450 resolution to know this new IP.
12451
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012452When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012453HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012454SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12455from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12456will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12457will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012458
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012459A few things important to notice:
12460 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12461 first valid response.
12462
12463 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12464 servers return an error.
12465
12466
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124675.3.2. The resolvers section
12468----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012469
12470This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012471HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12472contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012473
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012474When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12475uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12476is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12477answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12478
12479When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012480used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012481
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012482 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12483 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12484 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012485
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012486 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12487 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012488
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012489 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12490 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12491 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012492
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012493For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12494following scenarios are possible:
12495
12496 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12497 ignored
12498
12499 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12500 applied
12501
12502 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12503 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12504
12505 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12506 retries the query with a new type
12507
12508 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12509 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012510
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012511As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12512a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012513<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012514
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012515
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012516resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012517 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012518
12519A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12520
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012521accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012522 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012523 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012524 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12525 by RFC 6891)
12526
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012527 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12528
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012529nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12530 DNS server description:
12531 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12532 <ip> : IP address of the server
12533 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12534
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012535parse-resolv-conf
12536 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12537 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12538 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12539
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012540hold <status> <period>
12541 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12542 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012543 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012544 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012545 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12546 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12547 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12548
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012549 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012550
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012551resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012552 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12553 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12554 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12555
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012556resolve_retries <nb>
12557 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12558 giving up.
12559 Default value: 3
12560
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012561 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12562 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12563 type.
12564
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012565timeout <event> <time>
12566 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12567 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12568 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012569 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12570 other time applied.
12571 Default value: 1s
12572 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12573 have been received.
12574 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012575 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12576 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12577
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012578 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012579
12580 resolvers mydns
12581 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12582 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012583 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012584 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012585 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012586 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012587 hold other 30s
12588 hold refused 30s
12589 hold nx 30s
12590 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012591 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012592 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012593
12594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125956. HTTP header manipulation
12596---------------------------
12597
12598In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12599response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12600request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12601which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012602against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012604If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12605to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12606but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12607HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12608stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12609because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12610a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12611still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012613This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12614in section 4.2 :
12615
12616 - reqadd <string>
12617 - reqallow <search>
12618 - reqiallow <search>
12619 - reqdel <search>
12620 - reqidel <search>
12621 - reqdeny <search>
12622 - reqideny <search>
12623 - reqpass <search>
12624 - reqipass <search>
12625 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12626 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12627 - reqtarpit <search>
12628 - reqitarpit <search>
12629 - rspadd <string>
12630 - rspdel <search>
12631 - rspidel <search>
12632 - rspdeny <search>
12633 - rspideny <search>
12634 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12635 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12636
12637With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12638is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12639parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12640prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12641Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12642
12643 \t for a tab
12644 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12645 \n for a new line (LF)
12646 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12647 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12648 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12649 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12650 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12651
12652The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12653portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12654above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12655regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126569 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12657is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12658
12659The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12660after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12661
12662Notes related to these keywords :
12663---------------------------------
12664 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12665 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12666 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12667
12668 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12669 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12670 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12671
12672 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12673 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12674 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12675 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12676 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12677
12678 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12679 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12680 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12681 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12682 useless headers before adding new ones.
12683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012684 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012685 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12686
12687 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12688 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12689 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12690
12691 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12692 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012693 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012694
12695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126967. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12697----------------------------------
12698
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012699HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012700client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12701The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12702these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12703but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12704data called patterns.
12705
12706
127077.1. ACL basics
12708---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012709
12710The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12711content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12712from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12713simple :
12714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012715 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012716 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012717 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12718 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12721adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012722
12723In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012725 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012726
12727This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12728Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12729and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012730an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12731conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12732as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12733are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012734
12735ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12736'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12737which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12738
12739There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12740performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012742The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12743specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12744this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012745methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12746ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747
12748Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12749 - boolean
12750 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12751 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12752 - string
12753 - data block
12754
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012755Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12756converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12757would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12758The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12759which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12760
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012761Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12762keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12763fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12764which are summarized in the table below :
12765
12766 +---------------------+-----------------+
12767 | Sample or converter | Default |
12768 | output type | matching method |
12769 +---------------------+-----------------+
12770 | boolean | bool |
12771 +---------------------+-----------------+
12772 | integer | int |
12773 +---------------------+-----------------+
12774 | ip | ip |
12775 +---------------------+-----------------+
12776 | string | str |
12777 +---------------------+-----------------+
12778 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12779 +---------------------+-----------------+
12780
12781Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12782matching method, see below.
12783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012784The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12785 - boolean
12786 - integer or integer range
12787 - IP address / network
12788 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12789 - regular expression
12790 - hex block
12791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012792The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12793
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012794 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12795 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012796 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012797 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012798 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012799 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012800 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012802The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12803read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12804if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12805lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12806will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12807beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12808a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12809lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12810exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12811
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012812The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12813parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12814ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12815a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12816check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12817
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012818The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12819socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12820file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12823loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12824
12825 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12826
12827In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12828the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12829case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12830as well.
12831
12832The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12833sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12834do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12835methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12836is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012837obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012838followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12839default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12840that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12841string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12842
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012843The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12844By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12845string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12846resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12847server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12848waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12849flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12850function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012852There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12853sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12854be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012855
12856 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12857 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12859 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12860 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12861 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012862
12863 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12864 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012866
12867 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012868 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012869
12870 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012871 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012872
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012873 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012874 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12875
12876 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12877 binary or string samples.
12878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012879 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12880 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012882 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12883 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12884 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012886 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12887 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012889 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12890 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012892 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12893 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012895 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12896 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012897 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012899 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12900 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12901 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012902
12903For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12904request, it is possible to do :
12905
12906 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12907
12908In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12909buffer, one would use the following acl :
12910
12911 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12912
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012913On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12914possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12915
12916 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12919criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12920method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12921to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12922criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12923the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012926the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12927For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012929 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12930 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12931 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12932 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012933
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012934
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012935The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12936types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12937combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12938brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12939default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012941 +-------------------------------------------------+
12942 | Input sample type |
12943 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012944 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012945 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12946 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12947 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012948 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012950 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012951 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012952 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012954 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012955 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012956 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012957 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012958 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012959 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012960 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012961 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012962 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012964 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012966 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012967 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012968 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012969 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12970 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12971 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012972
12973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129747.1.1. Matching booleans
12975------------------------
12976
12977In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12978Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12979When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12980that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12981
12982Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12983return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12984"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12985
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129877.1.2. Matching integers
12988------------------------
12989
12990Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12991enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12992to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12993
12994Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12995matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12996lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012997
12998For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12999unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13000representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13001
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013002As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13003two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13004instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13005ranges and operators.
13006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013007For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013008operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13009Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13010of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013011
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013012Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013013
13014 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13015 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13016 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13017 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13018 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13019
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013020For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013021
13022 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13023
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013024This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13025
13026 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13027
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130297.1.3. Matching strings
13030-----------------------
13031
13032String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13033different forms :
13034
13035 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013036 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013037
13038 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013039 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040
13041 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13042 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13043
13044 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13045 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13046
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013047 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013048 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13049 matches.
13050
13051 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13052 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13053 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013054
13055String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13056exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13057characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13058string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13059to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013060before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013061
13062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130637.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13064---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013065
13066Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13067they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13068possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13069passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13070the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013071the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13072match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013073
13074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13076-------------------------------------
13077
13078It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13079not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13080a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13081to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13082digits may be used upper or lower case.
13083
13084Example :
13085 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13086 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13087
13088
130897.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13090---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013091
13092IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13093netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13094within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013095host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013096difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13097at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13098does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13099parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013100
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013101The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13102abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13103
13104 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13105 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13106 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13107 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13108 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13109 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13110 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13111 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13112
13113Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13114192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13115
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013116IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13117Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13118trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13119IPv6 patterns.
13120
13121HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13122following situations :
13123 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13124 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13125 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13126 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13127 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13128 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13129 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13130 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13131 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13132 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013134
131357.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13136----------------------------------
13137
13138Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13139combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13140
13141 - AND (implicit)
13142 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13143 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013147 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013149Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13150indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013152For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13153"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13154requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13155is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13156
13157 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013158 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13159 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13160 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161
13162To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13163and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13164
13165 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13166 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13167 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13168 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13169
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013170 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13172 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13173 use_backend www if host_www
13174
13175It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13176expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13177be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13178the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13179
13180 The following rule :
13181
13182 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013183 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013184
13185 Can also be written that way :
13186
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013187 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013188
13189It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13190to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13191simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13192sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13193good use is the following :
13194
13195 With named ACLs :
13196
13197 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13198 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13199 monitor fail if site_dead
13200
13201 With anonymous ACLs :
13202
13203 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13204
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013205See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13206keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013207
13208
132097.3. Fetching samples
13210---------------------
13211
13212Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13213against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13214sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13215ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13216of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13217available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13218
13219This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13220Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13221compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13222deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13223
13224The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13225matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13226method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13227indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13228
13229As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13230when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13231mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13232the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13233ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13234
13235Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13236multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13237when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013238incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13239are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013240is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13241all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13242
13243Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13244 - name
13245 - name(arg1)
13246 - name(arg1,arg2)
13247
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013248
132497.3.1. Converters
13250-----------------
13251
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013252Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13253of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13254is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13255was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013256has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013257unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13258
13259These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13260sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13261the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013262support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013263
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013264A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13265support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13266supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13267(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13268bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013271
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001327251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13273 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13274 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13275 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13276 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13277 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13278
13279 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013280 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13281 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013282 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13283 frontend http-in
13284 bind *:8081
13285 default_backend servers
13286 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13287 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13288
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013289add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013290 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013291 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013292 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13293 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013294 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013295 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13296 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13297 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13298 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013299 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013300 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013301
13302and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013303 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013304 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013305 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13306 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013307 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013308 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13309 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13310 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13311 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013312 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013313 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013314
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013315b64dec
13316 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13317 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13318
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013319base64
13320 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013321 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013322 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13323
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013324bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013325 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013326 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013327 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013328 presence of a flag).
13329
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013330bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13331 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13332 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013333 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013334
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013335concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13336 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13337 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13338 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13339 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13340 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13341 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13342 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13343 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13344 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13345 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13346 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13347 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13348 delimitors.
13349
13350 Example:
13351 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13352 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13353 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13354 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13355
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013356cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013357 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13358 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013359
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013360crc32([<avalanche>])
13361 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13362 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13363 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13364 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13365 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13366 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13367 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13368 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13369 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13370 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013371 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13372
13373crc32c([<avalanche>])
13374 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13375 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13376 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13377 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13378 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13379 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13380 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13381 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013382
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013383da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013384 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13385 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13386 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13387 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013388 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013389 configuration language.
13390
13391 Example:
13392 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013393 bind *:8881
13394 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013395 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013396
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013397debug
13398 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13399 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13400 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13401
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013402div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013403 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13404 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013405 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013406 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13407 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013408 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013409 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13410 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13411 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13412 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013413 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013414 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013415
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013416djb2([<avalanche>])
13417 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13418 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13419 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13420 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13421 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13422 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13423 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013424 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13425 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013426
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013427even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013428 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013429 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13430
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013431field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13432 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13433 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13434 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13435 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13436 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13437 fields.
13438
13439 Example :
13440 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13441 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13442 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13443 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13444 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013445
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013446hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013447 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013448 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013449 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013450 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013451
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013452hex2i
13453 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13454 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13455
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013456http_date([<offset>])
13457 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13458 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13459 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13460 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13461 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13462 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013464in_table(<table>)
13465 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13466 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13467 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013468 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013469 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13470
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013471ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13472 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013473 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013474 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13475 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13476 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13477 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13478 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013479
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013480json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013481 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013482 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013483 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013484 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13485 of errors:
13486 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13487 bytes, ...)
13488 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13489 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13490
13491 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13492 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13493 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13494 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13495 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13496 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013497 - "ascii" : never fails;
13498 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13499 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013500 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013501 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013502 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13503 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13504
13505 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013506 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013507
13508 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013509 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013510 capture request header user-agent len 150
13511 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013512
13513 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13514 GET / HTTP/1.0
13515 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13516
13517 Output log:
13518 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13519
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013520language(<value>[,<default>])
13521 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13522 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13523 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13524 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13525 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13526 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13527 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13528 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13529 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013530 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013531 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13532 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013534 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013535
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013536 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13537 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013538
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013539 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13540 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13541 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13542 use_backend spanish if es
13543 use_backend french if fr
13544 use_backend english if en
13545 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013546
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013547length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013548 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13549 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13550 type. The result is of type integer.
13551
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013552lower
13553 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13554 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13555 type. The result is of type string.
13556
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013557ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13558 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13559 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13560 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13561 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13562 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13563 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13564
13565 Example :
13566
13567 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013568 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013569 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13570
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013571map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13572map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13573map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13574 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13575 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13576 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13577 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13578 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13579 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13580 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13581 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013582
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013583 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13584 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13585 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013586
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013587 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013588 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013590 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13591 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13592 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13593 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013594 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13595 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013596 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13597 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13598 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13599 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13600 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13601 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13602 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13603 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013604 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13605 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13606 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013607 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13608 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13609 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13610 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13611 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013612
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013613 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13614 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13615 the corresponding match text.
13616
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013617 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13618 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13619 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13620 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13621 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013622
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013623 Example :
13624
13625 # this is a comment and is ignored
13626 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13627 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13628 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13629 | | | `---------- value
13630 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13631 | `---------------------------- key
13632 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13633
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013634mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013635 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13636 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013637 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013638 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013639 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013640 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13641 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13642 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013645 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013646
13647mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013648 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013649 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13650 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013651 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013652 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013653 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013654 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13655 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13656 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13657 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013658 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013659 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013660
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013661nbsrv
13662 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13663 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13664 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13665 map lookup.
13666
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013667neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013668 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13669 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13670 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13671 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013672
13673not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013674 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013675 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013676 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013677 absence of a flag).
13678
13679odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013680 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013681 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13682
13683or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013684 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013685 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013686 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13687 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013688 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013689 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13690 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13691 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13692 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013694 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013695
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013696regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013697 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13698 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13699 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13700 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13701 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13702 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13703 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13704 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13705 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13706 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013707 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13708 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13709 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13710 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013711
13712 Example :
13713
13714 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13715 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13716 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13717 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13718
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013719capture-req(<id>)
13720 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13721 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13722
13723 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013724 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13725 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013726
13727capture-res(<id>)
13728 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13729 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13730
13731 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013732 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13733 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013734
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013735sdbm([<avalanche>])
13736 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13737 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13738 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13739 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13740 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13741 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13742 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013743 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13744 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013745
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013746set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013747 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13748 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13749 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013750 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013751 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13752 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013753 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013754 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13755 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013756 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013757 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013758
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013759sha1
13760 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13761 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13762
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013763strcmp(<var>)
13764 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13765 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13766 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13767 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13768 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13769 shorter).
13770
13771 Example :
13772
13773 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13774 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13775 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13776
13777
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013778sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013779 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13780 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013781 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013782 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13783 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13786 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013787 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013788 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13789 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013790 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013791 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013792
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010013793svarint
13794 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers signed "varints" ("sint32"
13795 and "sint64") to an integer.
13796 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message types:
13797 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13798
13799varint
13800 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers "varints", excepted
13801 the signed ones "sint32" and "sint64", to an integer.
13802 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message types:
13803 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13804
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013805table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13809 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13810 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13811 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13812
13813
13814table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13815 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13816 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13817 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13818 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13819 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13820 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13821
13822table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13823 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13824 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013825 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013826 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13827 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13828
13829table_conn_cur(<table>)
13830 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13831 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13832 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13833 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13834 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13835
13836table_conn_rate(<table>)
13837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13839 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13840 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13841 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13842
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013843table_gpt0(<table>)
13844 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13845 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13846 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13847 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13848 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13849
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013850table_gpc0(<table>)
13851 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13852 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13853 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13854 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13855 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13856
13857table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13860 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13861 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13862 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13863 sample fetch keyword.
13864
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013865table_gpc1(<table>)
13866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13869 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13870 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13871
13872table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13873 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13874 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13875 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13876 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13877 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13878 sample fetch keyword.
13879
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013880table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013884 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13885 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13886
13887table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13890 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13891 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13892 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13893 keyword.
13894
13895table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013899 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13900 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13901
13902table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13903 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13904 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13905 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13906 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13907 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13908 keyword.
13909
13910table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013914 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13915 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13916 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13917 keyword.
13918
13919table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13920 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13921 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013922 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013923 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13924 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13925 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13926 keyword.
13927
13928table_server_id(<table>)
13929 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13930 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13931 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13932 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13933 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13934 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13935
13936table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13937 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13938 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013939 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013940 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13941 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13942 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13943 keyword.
13944
13945table_sess_rate(<table>)
13946 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13947 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13948 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13949 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13950 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13951 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13952 keyword.
13953
13954table_trackers(<table>)
13955 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13956 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13957 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13958 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13959 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13960 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13961 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13962 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13963 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13964 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13965
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013966upper
13967 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13968 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13969 type. The result is of type string.
13970
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013971url_dec
13972 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13973 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13974
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013975unset-var(<var name>)
13976 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13977 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13978 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13979 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13980 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13981 response),
13982 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13983 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13984 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13985 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13986
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013987utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13988 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13989 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13990 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13991 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13992 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13993 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13994
13995 Example :
13996
13997 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013998 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013999 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14000
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014001word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14002 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14003 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14004 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14005 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14006 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14007
14008 Example :
14009 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14010 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14011 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14012 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14013 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014014
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014015wt6([<avalanche>])
14016 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14017 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14018 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14019 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14020 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14021 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14022 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014023 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14024 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014025
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014026xor(<value>)
14027 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014028 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014029 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014030 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014031 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014032 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14033 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014034 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014035 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14036 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014037 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014038 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014039
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014040xxh32([<seed>])
14041 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14042 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14043 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14044 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14045 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14046 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14047 as cryptographically secure.
14048
14049xxh64([<seed>])
14050 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14051 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14052 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14053 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14054 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14055 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14056 as cryptographically secure.
14057
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014058
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140597.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014060--------------------------------------------
14061
14062A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14063not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14064"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14065The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14066
14067always_false : boolean
14068 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14069 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14070
14071always_true : boolean
14072 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14073 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14074
14075avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014076 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014077 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14078 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14079 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14080 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14081 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14082 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14083 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14084 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14085 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14086 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14087 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14088 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14089 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014091be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014092 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14093 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14094 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14095 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014096 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14097
14098be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14099 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14100 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14101 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14102 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14103 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014104 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14105 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014106
14107 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14108 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14109 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014111be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14112 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14113 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14114 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014115 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014116 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14117 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014118
14119 Example :
14120 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14121 backend dynamic
14122 mode http
14123 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14124 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014125
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014126bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014127 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14128 of the string.
14129
14130bool(<bool>) : bool
14131 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14132 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014134connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14135 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014136 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014137 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14138 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014139
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014140 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014141 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014142 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14143
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014144 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14145 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014146
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014147 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014148 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014149 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014150 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014151 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014152 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014153 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014154
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014155 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14156 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014158 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014159
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014160cpu_calls : integer
14161 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14162 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14163 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14164 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14165 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14166 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14167
14168cpu_ns_avg : integer
14169 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14170 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14171 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14172 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14173 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14174 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14175 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14176 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14177 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14178 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14179 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14180
14181cpu_ns_tot : integer
14182 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14183 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14184 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14185 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14186 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14187 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14188 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14189 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14190 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14191 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14192 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14193 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14194 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14195
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014196date([<offset>]) : integer
14197 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14198 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14199 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14200 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014201 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14202
14203 Example :
14204
14205 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14206 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014207
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014208date_us : integer
14209 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14210 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14211 from the same timeval structure.
14212
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014213distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14214 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14215 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14216 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14217 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14218 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14219 list of supported tokens.
14220
14221distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14222 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14223 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14224 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14225 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14226 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14227 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14228 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14229 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14230 supported tokens.
14231
14232 Example :
14233 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14234 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14235 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14236 # send large files to the big farm
14237 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14238
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014239env(<name>) : string
14240 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14241 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14242 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14243 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14244 certain way.
14245
14246 Examples :
14247 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14248 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14249
14250 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14251 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14254 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014255 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14256 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14258 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014259 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014260 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14261 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014262
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014263fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14264 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14265 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14266 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14269 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14270 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14271 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14272 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14273 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14274 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14275 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14276 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014277
14278 Example :
14279 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14280 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14281 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14282 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14283 frontend mail
14284 bind :25
14285 mode tcp
14286 maxconn 100
14287 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14288 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14289 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14290 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014291
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014292hostname : string
14293 Returns the system hostname.
14294
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014295int(<integer>) : signed integer
14296 Returns a signed integer.
14297
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014298ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14299 Returns an ipv4.
14300
14301ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14302 Returns an ipv6.
14303
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014304lat_ns_avg : integer
14305 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14306 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14307 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14308 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14309 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14310 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14311 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14312 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14313 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14314 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14315 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14316 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14317 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14318 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14319
14320lat_ns_tot : integer
14321 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14322 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14323 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14324 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14325 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14326 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14327 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14328 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14329 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14330 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14331 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14332 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14333 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14334 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14335 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14336 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14337 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14338 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14339 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14340
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014341meth(<method>) : method
14342 Returns a method.
14343
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014344nbproc : integer
14345 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14346 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14347 and debugging purposes.
14348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14350 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14351 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14352 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014353 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14354 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14355 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014356
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014357prio_class : integer
14358 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14359 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14360 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14361
14362prio_offset : integer
14363 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14364 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14365 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14366 set-priority-offset".
14367
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014368proc : integer
14369 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14370 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14371 debugging purposes.
14372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014374 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14375 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14376 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14378 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14379 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14380 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14381 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14382
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014383rand([<range>]) : integer
14384 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14385 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14386 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14387 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14388 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014390srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14392 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14393 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14394 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14395 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014396 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14397 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14398
14399srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14400 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14401 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14402 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14403 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14404 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14405 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14406 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14407
14408 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14409 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014410
14411srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14412 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14413 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14414 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014415 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014416 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14417 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14418 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14419
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014420srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14421 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14422 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14423 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14424 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14425 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14426 fetch methods.
14427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14429 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14430 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014431 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14433 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014434 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435 overloading servers).
14436
14437 Example :
14438 # Redirect to a separate back
14439 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14440 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14441 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14442
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014443stopping : boolean
14444 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14445 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14446 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14447
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014448str(<string>) : string
14449 Returns a string.
14450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014451table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14452 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14453 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14454
14455table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14456 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14457 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14458 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14459
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014460thread : integer
14461 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14462 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14463 and debugging purposes.
14464
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014465var(<var-name>) : undefined
14466 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014467 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14468 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014469 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014470 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14471 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014472 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014473 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14474 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014475 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014476 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014477
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144787.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014479----------------------------------
14480
14481The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14482closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14483methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14484sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14485TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014486the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14487counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014488"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14489used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14490can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14491Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14492table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14493tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14494currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014496bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014497 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14498 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14499 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501be_id : integer
14502 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14503 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14504
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014505be_name : string
14506 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14507 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509dst : ip
14510 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14511 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14512 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14513 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014514 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14515 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14516 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14517 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14518 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14519 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520
14521dst_conn : integer
14522 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14523 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14524 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14525 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14526 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14527 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14528 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14529 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014530
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014531dst_is_local : boolean
14532 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14533 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14534 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14535 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014536 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014537 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14538 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14539 it only once per connection.
14540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014541dst_port : integer
14542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14543 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14544 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14545 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14546 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14547 an HTTP header.
14548
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014549fc_http_major : integer
14550 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14551 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14552 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14553
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014554fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14555 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14556 header.
14557
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014558fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14559 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14560 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14561 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14562 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14563 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14564 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14565
14566fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14567 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14568 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14569 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14570 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14571 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14572 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14573
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014574fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14575 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14576 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14577 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14578 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14579
14580fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14581 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14582 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14583 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14584 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14585
14586fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14587 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14588 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14589 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14590 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14591
14592fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14593 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14594 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14595 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14596 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14597
14598fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14599 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14600 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14601 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14602 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14603
14604fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14605 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14606 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14607 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14608 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14609
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014610fe_defbe : string
14611 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14612 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014614fe_id : integer
14615 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014616 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014617 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14618
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014619fe_name : string
14620 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14621 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14622 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14623
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014624sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014625sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14626sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14627sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014628 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14629 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14630 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14631
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014632sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014633sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14634sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14635sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014636 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14637 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14638 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14639
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014640sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014641sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14642sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14643sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014644 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14645 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014646 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14647 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14648 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014649
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014650 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014651 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14652 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014653 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14654 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14655 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014656 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14657 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14658
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014659sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14660sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14661sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14662sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14663 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14664 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14665 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14666 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14667 when a first ACL was verified.
14668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014669sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014670sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14671sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14672sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014673 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014674 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14675
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014676sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014677sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14678sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14679sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014680 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14681 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14682 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14683
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014684sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014685sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14686sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14687sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014688 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14689 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14690 See also src_conn_rate.
14691
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014692sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014693sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14694sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14695sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014696 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014697 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014698
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014699sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14700sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14701sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14702sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14703 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14704 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14705
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014706sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14707sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14708sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14709sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14710 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14711 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14712
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014713sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014714sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14715sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14716sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014717 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14718 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14719 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014720 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14721 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14722 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014723
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014724sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14725sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14726sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14727sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14728 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14729 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14730 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14731 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14732 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14733 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14734
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014735sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014736sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14737sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14738sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014739 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014740 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14741 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014743sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014744sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14745sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14746sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014747 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14748 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14749 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14750 src_http_err_rate.
14751
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014752sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014753sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14754sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14755sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014757 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14758 src_http_req_cnt.
14759
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014760sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014761sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14762sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14763sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014764 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14765 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14766 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14767 src_http_req_rate.
14768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014769sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014770sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14771sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14772sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014773 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014774 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14775 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14776 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14777 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014778
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014779 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014780 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14781 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014782 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14783
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014784sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14785sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14786sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14787sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14788 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14789 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14790 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14791 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14792 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14793
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014794sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014795sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14796sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14797sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014798 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14799 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14800 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014801
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014802sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014803sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14804sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14805sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014806 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14807 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14808 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014809
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014810sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014811sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14812sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14813sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014814 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014815 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14816 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14817 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014818 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014819 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14820
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014821sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014822sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14823sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14824sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014825 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14826 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14827 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14828 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14829 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014830 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014832sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014833sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14834sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14835sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014836 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14837 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14838 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14839
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014840sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014841sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14842sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14843sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014844 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14845 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014846 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014847 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14848 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14850 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14851 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853so_id : integer
14854 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14855 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14856 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014859 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014860 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14861 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14862 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014863 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14864 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14865 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014866 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14867 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14868 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14869 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14870 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14871 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14872 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014873
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014874 Example:
14875 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14876 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14879 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14880 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14881 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014882 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14885 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14886 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014887 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014888 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14891 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14892 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14893 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14894 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14895 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14896 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014897
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014898 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014899 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14900 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14901 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14902 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014903 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014904 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14905 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14906
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014907src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14908 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14909 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14910 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14911 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14912 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14913 was verified.
14914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014915src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014916 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014917 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014918 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014919 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014921src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014922 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014923 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14924 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014925 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14928 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14929 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14930 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014931 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014933src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014934 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014935 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014936 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014937 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014938
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014939src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14940 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14941 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14942 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14943 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14944
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014945src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14946 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14947 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14948 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14949 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014951src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014952 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014954 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14955 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014956 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14957 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14958 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014959
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014960src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14961 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14962 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14963 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14964 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14965 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14966 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14967 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014970 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014971 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014972 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014973 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014976src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14977 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14978 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14979 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14980 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014981 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014983src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014984 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14986 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014987 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014989src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14990 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14991 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14992 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014993 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014994 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014996src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14997 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14998 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14999 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015000 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15002 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015003
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015004 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015005 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015006 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015007 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015008
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015009src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15010 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15011 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15012 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15013 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15014 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15015 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15016
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015017src_is_local : boolean
15018 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15019 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15020 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15021 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015022 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015023 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15024 once per connection.
15025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015027 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15028 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15029 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15030 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15031 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015033src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015034 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15035 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15036 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15037 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15038 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015040src_port : integer
15041 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15042 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15043 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15044 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015047 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015048 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15049 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15050 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015051 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15054 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15055 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15056 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15057 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015058 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15061 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15062 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15063 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15064 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15065 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15066 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15067 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15068 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015069
15070 Example :
15071 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15072 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15073 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15074 listen ssh
15075 bind :22
15076 mode tcp
15077 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015078 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015080 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082srv_id : integer
15083 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15084 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15085 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015086
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15091closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15092when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15093usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015094future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015095
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001509651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15097 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15098 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15099 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15100 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15101 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15102
15103 Example :
15104 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15105 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15106 # the request.
15107 frontend http-in
15108 bind *:8081
15109 default_backend servers
15110 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15111 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15112
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015113ssl_bc : boolean
15114 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15115 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15116 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15117
15118ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15119 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15120 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15121
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015122ssl_bc_alpn : string
15123 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15124 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15125 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15126 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15127 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15128 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15129 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15130 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15131 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15132
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015133ssl_bc_cipher : string
15134 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15135 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15136
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015137ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15138 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15139 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15140 session or a TLS ticket.
15141
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015142ssl_bc_npn : string
15143 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15144 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15145 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15146 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15147 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15148 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15149 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15150 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15151
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015152ssl_bc_protocol : string
15153 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15154 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15155
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015156ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015157 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015158 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15159 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015160
15161ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15162 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15163 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15164 if session was reused or not.
15165
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015166ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15167 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15168 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15169 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15170 BoringSSL.
15171
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015172ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15173 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15174 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15177 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15178 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15179 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15180 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15181 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015183ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15184 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15185 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15186 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15187 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015188
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015189ssl_c_der : binary
15190 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15191 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15192 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015194ssl_c_err : integer
15195 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15196 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15197 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15198 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15199 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15202 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15203 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15204 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15205 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15206 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15207 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15208 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15209 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211ssl_c_key_alg : string
15212 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15213 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15214 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216ssl_c_notafter : string
15217 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15218 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15219 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221ssl_c_notbefore : string
15222 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15223 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15224 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15227 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15228 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15229 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15230 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15231 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15232 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15233 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15234 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236ssl_c_serial : binary
15237 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15238 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15239 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015241ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15242 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15243 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15244 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015245 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15246 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15247
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015248 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015249 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15252 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15253 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15254 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256ssl_c_used : boolean
15257 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15258 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260ssl_c_verify : integer
15261 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15262 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15263 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15264 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266ssl_c_version : integer
15267 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15268 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015269
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015270ssl_f_der : binary
15271 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15272 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15273 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15276 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15277 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15278 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15279 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015280 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15282 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15283 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285ssl_f_key_alg : string
15286 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15287 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15288 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290ssl_f_notafter : string
15291 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15292 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15293 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295ssl_f_notbefore : string
15296 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15297 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15298 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15301 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15302 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15303 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15304 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15305 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15306 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15307 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15308 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310ssl_f_serial : binary
15311 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15312 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15313 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015314
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015315ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15316 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15317 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15318 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15321 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15322 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15323 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325ssl_f_version : integer
15326 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15327 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15328
15329ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015330 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15331 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15332 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334 Example :
15335 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15336 listen http-https
15337 bind :80
15338 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15339 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15340
15341ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15342 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15343 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15344
15345ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015346 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015347 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15348 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15349 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15350 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15351 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15352 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15353 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15354 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015356ssl_fc_cipher : string
15357 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15358 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015359
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015360ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15361 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15362 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015363 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015364
15365ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15366 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15367 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015368 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015369
15370ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15371 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15372 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15373 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015374 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015375 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015376
15377ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15378 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15379 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015380 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015383 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15384 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015385 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15386 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15387 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15388 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015389
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015390ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15391 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15392 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15393 wait until the handshake happened.
15394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015395ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15396 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015397 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15398 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15399 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15400 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015401
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015402ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015403 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015404 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15405 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015407ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015408 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15410 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15411 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15412 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15413 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15414 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15415 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417ssl_fc_protocol : string
15418 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15419 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015420
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015421ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015422 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015423 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15424 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015426ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15427 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15428 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15429 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15430 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015431
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015432ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15433 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15434 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15435 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15436 BoringSSL.
15437
15438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439ssl_fc_sni : string
15440 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15441 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15442 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15443 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15444 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15445
15446 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15447 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15448 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015449 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15450 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015453 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15454 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015456ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15457 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15458 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015459
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015460
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154617.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015464Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15465sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15466only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15467For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15468be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15469can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15470sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15471for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15472content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015475 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15477 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15480 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015481 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015483
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015484req.hdrs : string
15485 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15486 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15487 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15488 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15489
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015490req.hdrs_bin : binary
15491 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15492 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15493 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15494 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15495 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15496 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15497
15498 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15499
15500 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15501 str: <int:length><bytes>
15502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503req.len : integer
15504req_len : integer (deprecated)
15505 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15506 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15507 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15508 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15509 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15510 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15511 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15512 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15515 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015516 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15517 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15518 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15519 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521 ACL alternatives :
15522 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15525 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15526 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15527 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15528 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530 ACL alternatives :
15531 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535req.proto_http : boolean
15536req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15537 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15538 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15539 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15540 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15541 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15542 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15543 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545 Example:
15546 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15547 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15548 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015549 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15552rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15553 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15554 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15555 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15556 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15557 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15558 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15559 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15562 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15563 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15564 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15565 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15566 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568 ACL derivatives :
15569 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 Example :
15572 listen tse-farm
15573 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15574 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15575 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15576 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15577 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15578 persist rdp-cookie
15579 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15580 # This is only useful makes sense if
15581 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15582 stick-table type string size 204800
15583 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15584 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15585 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15588 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15591rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15592 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15593 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15594 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15595 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597 ACL derivatives :
15598 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015599
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015600req.ssl_alpn : string
15601 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15602 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15603 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15604 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15605 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15606 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015607 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015608
15609 Examples :
15610 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15611 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15612 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015613 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015614 default_backend bk_default
15615
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015616req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15617 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15618 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015619 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15620 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15621 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15622 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15623 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15626req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15627 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15628 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15629 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15630 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15631 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15632 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15633 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635req.ssl_sni : string
15636req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15637 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15638 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15639 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15640 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15641 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15642 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15643 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15644 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15645 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15646 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15647 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15648 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650 ACL derivatives :
15651 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 Examples :
15654 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15655 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15656 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15657 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15658 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015659
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015660req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15661 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15662 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15663 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15664 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15665 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15666 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15667 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15668 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15669 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015671req.ssl_ver : integer
15672req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15673 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15674 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15675 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15676 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15677 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15678 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15679 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015680 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683 ACL derivatives :
15684 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015685
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015686res.len : integer
15687 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15688 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15689 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15690 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15691 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15692 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15693 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15694 content inspection.
15695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15697 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015698 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15699 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15700 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15701 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15704 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15705 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15706 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15707 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015710
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015711res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15712rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15713 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15714 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15715 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15716 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15717 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15718 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15719 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015721wait_end : boolean
15722 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15723 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015724 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15726 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015727 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15729 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731 Examples :
15732 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15733 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15734 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15737 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15738 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15739 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15740 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15741 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15742 tcp-request content reject
15743
15744
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157457.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746--------------------------------------
15747
15748It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15749This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15750data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15751its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15752HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15753content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15754to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15755more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15756response are indexed.
15757
15758base : string
15759 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15760 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15761 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15762 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15763 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15764 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15765 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15766 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15767
15768 ACL derivatives :
15769 base : exact string match
15770 base_beg : prefix match
15771 base_dir : subdir match
15772 base_dom : domain match
15773 base_end : suffix match
15774 base_len : length match
15775 base_reg : regex match
15776 base_sub : substring match
15777
15778base32 : integer
15779 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15780 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15781 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015782 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15783 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15784 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015785
15786base32+src : binary
15787 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15788 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15789 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15790 per-URL counters.
15791
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015792capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15793 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15794 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15795 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15796
15797capture.req.method : string
15798 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15799 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15800 because it's allocated.
15801
15802capture.req.uri : string
15803 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15804 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15805 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15806 allocated.
15807
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015808capture.req.ver : string
15809 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15810 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15811 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15812
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015813capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15814 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15815 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15816 The first entry is an index of 0.
15817 See also: "capture response header"
15818
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015819capture.res.ver : string
15820 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15821 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15822 persistent flag.
15823
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015824req.body : binary
15825 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15826 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15827 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15828 the first chunk is analyzed.
15829
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015830req.body_param([<name>) : string
15831 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15832 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15833 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15834 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15835 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15836 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15837 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15838 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15839 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15840 given.
15841
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015842req.body_len : integer
15843 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15844 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15845 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15846 "option http-buffer-request".
15847
15848req.body_size : integer
15849 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15850 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15851 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15852 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15853 "option http-buffer-request".
15854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855req.cook([<name>]) : string
15856cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15857 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15858 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15859 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15860 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15861 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15862 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15863 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15864 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15865
15866 ACL derivatives :
15867 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15868 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15869 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15870 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15871 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15872 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15873 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15874 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15877cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15878 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15879 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15882cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15883 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15884 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15885 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15886 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15889 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15890 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15891 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15892 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015893 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15895 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15896 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15897 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15900 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15901 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15902 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15903 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015904 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15907 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15908 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15909 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15910 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15911 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15912 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15913 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15914 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15917 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15918 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15919 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15920 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15923 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15924 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15925 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15926 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15927 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15928 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15929 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15930 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015931 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015933 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935 ACL derivatives :
15936 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15937 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15938 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15939 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15940 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15941 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15942 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15943 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15944
15945req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15946hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15947 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15948 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15949 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15950 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15951 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15952 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15953 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15954 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15955 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15956
15957req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15958hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15959 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15960 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15961 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15962 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15963 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015964 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15966 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15967
15968req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15969hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15970 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15971 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15972 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15973 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15974 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15975 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15976 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15977
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015978req.ungrpc(<field_number>) : binary
15979 This extracts the protocol buffers message in raw mode of a gRPC request body
15980 with <field_number> as terminal field number (dotted notation).
15981
15982 Example:
15983 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15984 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15985
15986 message Point {
15987 int32 latitude = 1;
15988 int32 longitude = 2;
15989 }
15990
15991 message PPoint {
15992 Point point = 59;
15993 }
15994
15995 message Rectangle {
15996 // One corner of the rectangle.
15997 PPoint lo = 48;
15998 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15999 PPoint hi = 49;
16000 }
16001
16002 Let's say a body requests is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16003 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers messages could be fetched
16004 with this "req.ungrpc" sample fetch directives:
16005
16006 req.ungrpc(48.59.1) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16007 req.ungrpc(48.59.2) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16008 req.ungrpc(49.59.1) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
16009 req.ungrpc(49.59.2) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16010
16011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016012http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16013 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16014 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16015 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16016 basic auth is supported.
16017
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016018http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16019 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16020 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16021 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16022 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16024 basic auth is supported.
16025
16026 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016027 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16028 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16029 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16030 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031
16032http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016033 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16034 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16036 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038method : integer + string
16039 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16040 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16041 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16042 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16043 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16044 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16045 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016047 ACL derivatives :
16048 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016050 Example :
16051 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16052 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16053 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016055path : string
16056 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16057 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16058 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16059 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16060 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016061 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064 ACL derivatives :
16065 path : exact string match
16066 path_beg : prefix match
16067 path_dir : subdir match
16068 path_dom : domain match
16069 path_end : suffix match
16070 path_len : length match
16071 path_reg : regex match
16072 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016073
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016074query : string
16075 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16076 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16077 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16078 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016079 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016080 which stops before the question mark.
16081
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016082req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16083 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16084 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16085 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16086 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088req.ver : string
16089req_ver : string (deprecated)
16090 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16091 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16092 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094 ACL derivatives :
16095 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097res.comp : boolean
16098 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16099 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16100 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102res.comp_algo : string
16103 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16104 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16105 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107res.cook([<name>]) : string
16108scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16109 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16110 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16111 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016113 ACL derivatives :
16114 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16117scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16118 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16119 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16120 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16123scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16124 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16125 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16126 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16129 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16130 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16131 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16132 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16133 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16134 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16135 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16136 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16137 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16140 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16141 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16142 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16143 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16144 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16147shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16148 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16149 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16150 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16151 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16152 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16153 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16154 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16155 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157 ACL derivatives :
16158 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16159 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16160 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16161 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16162 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16163 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16164 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16165 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16166
16167res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16168shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16169 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16170 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16171 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16172 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16173 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16176shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16177 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16178 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16179 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16180 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16181 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16182 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016183
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016184res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16185 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16186 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16187 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16188 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16191shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16192 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16193 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16194 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16195 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16196 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16197 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199res.ver : string
16200resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16201 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16202 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016204 ACL derivatives :
16205 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016207set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16208 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16209 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016210 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16214 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216status : integer
16217 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16218 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16219 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016220
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016221unique-id : string
16222 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16223 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16224 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16225 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16226 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16227 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229url : string
16230 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16231 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16232 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16233 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16234 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16235 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16236 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016238 ACL derivatives :
16239 url : exact string match
16240 url_beg : prefix match
16241 url_dir : subdir match
16242 url_dom : domain match
16243 url_end : suffix match
16244 url_len : length match
16245 url_reg : regex match
16246 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016248url_ip : ip
16249 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16250 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16251 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16252 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16253 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16254 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16255 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016257url_port : integer
16258 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16259 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16260 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16261 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016262
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016263urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16264url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016265 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16266 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016267 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16268 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16269 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16270 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016271 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16272 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016273 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16274 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276 ACL derivatives :
16277 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16278 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16279 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16280 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16281 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16282 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16283 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16284 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016285
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016287 Example :
16288 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16289 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16290 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16291 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016292
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016293urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16295 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16296 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016297
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016298url32 : integer
16299 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16300 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16301 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16302 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16303 is an unsigned integer.
16304
16305url32+src : binary
16306 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16307 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16308 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16309
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163117.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016312---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016314Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16315every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016316order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016318ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16319---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016320FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016321HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016322HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16323HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016324HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16325HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16326HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16327HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16328LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016329METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016330METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016331METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16332METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16333METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16334METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016335METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016336METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016337RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016338REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016339TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016340WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16341---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016342
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163448. Logging
16345----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016346
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016347One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16348provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16349very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16350provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16351state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016352to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016353headers.
16354
16355In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16356about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16357send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16358
16359 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16360 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16361 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16362 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16363 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016364 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016365 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016366
16367The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16368allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16369as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16370while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16371real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16372delay.
16373
16374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163758.1. Log levels
16376---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016377
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016378TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016379source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016380HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16381in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16382track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16383syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16384about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016385
16386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163878.2. Log formats
16388----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016389
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016390HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016391and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16392slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16393options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016394
16395 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16396 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16397 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16398 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16399 extents.
16400
16401 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16402 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16403 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16404 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16405 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16406
16407 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16408 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16409 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16410 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16411 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16412
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016413 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16414 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16415 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16416 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16417
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016418 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16419
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016420Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16421specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16422field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16423servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16424always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16425identifier.
16426
16427Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16428 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16429 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16430 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16431 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16432
16433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164348.2.1. Default log format
16435-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016436
16437This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16438as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16439format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16440
16441 Example :
16442 listen www
16443 mode http
16444 log global
16445 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16446
16447 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16448 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16449 (www/HTTP)
16450
16451 Field Format Extract from the example above
16452 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16453 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16454 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16455 4 'to' to
16456 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16457 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16458
16459Detailed fields description :
16460 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16461 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16462 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16463 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16464 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16465 and processed the connection.
16466 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16467
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016468In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16469"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16470connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16471
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016472It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16473will eventually disappear.
16474
16475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164768.2.2. TCP log format
16477---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016478
16479The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16480is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16481information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16482counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16483emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16484environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16485the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16486sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016487specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16488not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16489fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16490marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016491
16492 Example :
16493 frontend fnt
16494 mode tcp
16495 option tcplog
16496 log global
16497 default_backend bck
16498
16499 backend bck
16500 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16501
16502 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16503 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16504 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16505
16506 Field Format Extract from the example above
16507 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16508 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16509 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16510 4 frontend_name fnt
16511 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16512 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16513 7 bytes_read* 212
16514 8 termination_state --
16515 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16516 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16517
16518Detailed fields description :
16519 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016520 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16521 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16522 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016523 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016524 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016525 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016526
16527 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016528 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16529 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16530 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016531
16532 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16533 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16534 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016535 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16536 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16537 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16538 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016539
16540 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16541 and processed the connection.
16542
16543 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16544 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16545 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16546 applications.
16547
16548 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16549 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16550 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16551 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16552 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16553
16554 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16555 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16556 See "Timers" below for more details.
16557
16558 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16559 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16560 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16561 "Timers" below for more details.
16562
16563 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016564 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016565 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16566 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16567 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16568 details.
16569
16570 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16571 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16572 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16573 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16574 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16575
16576 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16577 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16578 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16579 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16580 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16581 for more details.
16582
16583 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016584 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016585 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16586 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16587 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016588 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016589
16590 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16591 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16592 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16593 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16594 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16595 caused by a denial of service attack.
16596
16597 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16598 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16599 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16600 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16601 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16602 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16603 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16604 denial of service attack.
16605
16606 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16607 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16608 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16609 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16610 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16611 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16612 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16613 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16614 be processed than on other servers.
16615
16616 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16617 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16618 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16619 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16620 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16621 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16622 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16623 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16624 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16625 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16626 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16627 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16628 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16629
16630 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16631 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16632 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16633 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16634 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16635 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016636 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016637 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16638
16639 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16640 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16641 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16642 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16643 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16644 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016645 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016646 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16647 occurs.
16648
16649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166508.2.3. HTTP log format
16651----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016652
16653The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16654is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16655the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16656are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16657emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16658generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16659"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16660which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016661frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16662is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016663
16664Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16665slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16666with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16667
16668 Example :
16669 frontend http-in
16670 mode http
16671 option httplog
16672 log global
16673 default_backend bck
16674
16675 backend static
16676 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16677
16678 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16679 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16680 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016681 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016682
16683 Field Format Extract from the example above
16684 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16685 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016686 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016687 4 frontend_name http-in
16688 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016689 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016690 7 status_code 200
16691 8 bytes_read* 2750
16692 9 captured_request_cookie -
16693 10 captured_response_cookie -
16694 11 termination_state ----
16695 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16696 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16697 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16698 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16699 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016701Detailed fields description :
16702 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016703 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16704 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16705 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016706 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016707 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016708 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016709
16710 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016711 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16712 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16713 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016714
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016715 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16716 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016717
16718 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16719 and processed the connection.
16720
16721 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16722 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16723 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16724
16725 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16726 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16727 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16728 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16729 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16730 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16731
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016732 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16733 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16734 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16735 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16736 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16737 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016738 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16739 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016740
16741 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16742 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016743 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016744
16745 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16746 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016747 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16748 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016749
16750 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16751 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16752 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16753 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16754 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016755 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16756 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016757
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016758 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16759 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16760 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16761 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16762 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16763 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16764 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016765 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016766
16767 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16768 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16769 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16770
16771 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16772 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16773 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16774 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16775 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16776 overflowing.
16777
16778 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16779 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16780 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16781 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16782 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16783 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16784 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16785 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16786
16787 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16788 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16789 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16790 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16791 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16792 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16793 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16794 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16795
16796 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16797 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16798 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16799 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16800 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16801 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16802 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16803
16804 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016805 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016806 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16807 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16808 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016809 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016810 system.
16811
16812 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16813 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16814 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16815 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16816 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16817 caused by a denial of service attack.
16818
16819 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16820 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16821 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16822 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16823 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16824 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16825 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16826 denial of service attack.
16827
16828 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16829 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16830 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16831 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16832 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16833 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16834 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16835 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16836 processed than on other servers.
16837
16838 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16839 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16840 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16841 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16842 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16843 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16844 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16845 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16846 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16847 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16848 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16849 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16850 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16851
16852 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16853 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16854 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16855 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16856 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16857 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016858 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016859 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16860
16861 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16862 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16863 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16864 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16865 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16866 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016867 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016868 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16869 occurs.
16870
16871 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16872 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16873 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16874 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16875 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16876 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16877 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16878 cookies" below for more details.
16879
16880 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16881 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16882 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16883 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16884 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16885 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16886 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16887 and cookies" below for more details.
16888
16889 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16890 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16891 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16892 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16893 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16894 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16895 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16896 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16897
16898
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168998.2.4. Custom log format
16900------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016901
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016902The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016903mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016904
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016905HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016906Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16907separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16908prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16909
16910Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16911variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016912("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016913
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016914If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016915as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016916less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16917the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16918
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016919Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016920In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016921in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016922
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016923Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16924'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16925https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16926such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16927
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016928Flags are :
16929 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016930 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016931 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16932 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016933
16934 Example:
16935
16936 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16937 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16938
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016939 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16940
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016941At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16942
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016943 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16944 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016945
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016946the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016947
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016948 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16949 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16950 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016951
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016952and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16953
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016954 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16955 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016956
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016957Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16958
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016959 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016960 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016961 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16962 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16963 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016964 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16965 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16966 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016967 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016968 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16969 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016970 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016971 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16972 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016973 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016974 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016975 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016976 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016977 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016978 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016979 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016980 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16981 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16982 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16983 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16984 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016985 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016986 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16987 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016988 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016989 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16990 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016991 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16992 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16993 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016994 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016995 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16996 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016997 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016998 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16999 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17000 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017001 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017002 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017003 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17004 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17005 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17006 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017007 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017008 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017009 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017010 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017011 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017012 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017013 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17014 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17015 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017016 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017017 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17018 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017019 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017020 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17021 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017022 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017023 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017024 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017025 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017026
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017027 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017028
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017029
170308.2.5. Error log format
17031-----------------------
17032
17033When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17034protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17035By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17036"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017037will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017038logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17039
17040The format looks like this :
17041
17042 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17043 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17044 Connection error during SSL handshake
17045
17046 Field Format Extract from the example above
17047 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17048 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17049 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17050 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17051 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17052
17053These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17054failures.
17055
17056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170578.3. Advanced logging options
17058-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017059
17060Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17061just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17062options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17063for more information about their usage.
17064
17065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170668.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17067------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017068
17069It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17070haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17071commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17072monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17073ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17074
17075 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17076 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17077 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17078 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17079
17080 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17081 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17082 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017083 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017084 such as other load-balancers.
17085
17086 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17087 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17088 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17089
17090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170918.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17092----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017093
17094The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17095what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17096or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017097"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017098just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17099log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17100after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17101is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17102with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17103with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17104
17105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17107------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017108
17109Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17110for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17111"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17112retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17113raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17114a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17115file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17116you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17117"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17118
17119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171208.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17121--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017122
17123Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17124multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17125them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17126"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17127logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17128error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17129and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17130too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17131useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17132alternative.
17133
17134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171358.4. Timing events
17136------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017137
17138Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17139reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17140the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17141frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017142mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17143addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17144
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017145Timings events in HTTP mode:
17146
17147 first request 2nd request
17148 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17149 t tr t tr ...
17150 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17151 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17152 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17153 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17154 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17155
17156Timings events in TCP mode:
17157
17158 TCP session
17159 |<----------------->|
17160 t t
17161 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17162 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17163 |<------ Tt ------->|
17164
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017165 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017166 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017167 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17168 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17169 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017170 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017171 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17172 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17173 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17174 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017175
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017176 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17177 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17178 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017179 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17180 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17181 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17182 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17183 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17184 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017185
17186 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17187 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17188 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17189 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17190 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17191 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17192 request typed by hand during a test.
17193
17194 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17195 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017196 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017197 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17198 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17199 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17200 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201
17202 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17203 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17204 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17205 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17206 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17207
17208 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17209 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17210 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17211 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17212 connection never established.
17213
17214 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17215 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17216 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17217 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17218 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17219 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17220 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17221 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17222 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17223 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17224 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17225
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017226 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17227 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17228 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17229 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17230 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17231 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17232
17233 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17234
17235 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17236 "Ta" can never be negative.
17237
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017238 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17239 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017240 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17241 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017242 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017243
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017244 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017245
17246 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017247 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17248 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017249
17250These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17251protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17252that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017253due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17254"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17255that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017256
17257Most common cases :
17258
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017259 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17260 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17261 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17262 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17263 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17264 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17265 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17266 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17267 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17268 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17269 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017270 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017271
17272 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17273 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17274 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17275 of ms on remote networks.
17276
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017277 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17278 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17279 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017280
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017281 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17282 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17283 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17284 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17285 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17286 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17287 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17288 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17289 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017290
17291Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17292
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017293 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017294 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017295 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017296
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017297 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017298 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17299 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17300
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017301 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017302 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17303 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17304 flags.
17305
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017306 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17307 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17309 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17310 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17311 the client connection was maintained open.
17312
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017313 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017314 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017315 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017316 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17317
17318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173198.5. Session state at disconnection
17320-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017321
17322TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17323"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173242-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17325each of which has a special meaning :
17326
17327 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17328 session to terminate :
17329
17330 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17331
17332 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17333 server explicitly refused it.
17334
17335 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17336 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17337 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17338 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017339 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017340
17341 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17342 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017343
17344 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17345 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17346 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17347 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17348 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17349
17350 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17351 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17352 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17353 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17354 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17355
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017356 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17357 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17358
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017359 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17360 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17361 backup connections when going up.
17362
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017363 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17364
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017365 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17366 send or receive data.
17367
17368 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17369 send or receive data.
17370
17371 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17372 with nothing left in the buffers.
17373
17374 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17375
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017376 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017377 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17378
17379 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17380 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17381 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17382 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17383 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17384
17385 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17386 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17387
17388 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17389 server (HTTP only).
17390
17391 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17392
17393 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17394 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17395 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17396
17397 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17398 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17399 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17400
17401 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17402
17403 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17404 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17405
17406 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17407 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17408 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17409
17410 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17411 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017412 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17413 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017414
17415 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17416 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17417 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17418 another server.
17419
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017420 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017421 server.
17422
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017423 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17424 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17425 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17426 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17427
17428 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17429 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17430 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17431 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17432
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017433 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17434 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17435 "use-server" rule).
17436
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017437 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17438
17439 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17440 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17441
17442 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17443
17444 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17445 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17446 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17447
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017448 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17449 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017450 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017451 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17452 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17453
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017454 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17455
17456 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17457 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17458
17459 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17460
17461 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17462
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017463The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17464was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017465helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17466starvation, attacks, etc...
17467
17468The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17469alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17470easier finding and understanding.
17471
17472 Flags Reason
17473
17474 -- Normal termination.
17475
17476 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17477 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17478 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17479 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17480
17481 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17482 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17483 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17484 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17485 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17486 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017487
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017488 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17489 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017490 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017491
17492 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17493 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17494 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17495
17496 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17497 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17498 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17499 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17500 the server takes too long to respond.
17501
17502 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17503 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17504 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17505 long a time to respond.
17506
17507 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17508 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17509 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17510 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017511 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17512 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017513
17514 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17515 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17516 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17517 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17518 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017519 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017520 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17521 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17522 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17523 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17524 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17525 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17526 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17527 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017528 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017529 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17530 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17531 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017532
17533 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17534 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017535 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17536 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17537 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17538 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017539
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017540 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17541 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17542
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017543 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17545 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017546 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017547 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17548 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17549
17550 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17551 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17552 503 or 504 here.
17553
17554 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17555 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17556 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17557 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17558 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17559
17560 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17561 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017562 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017563 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17564 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17565
17566 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17567 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17568 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17569 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17570 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17571 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17572 between haproxy and the server.
17573
17574 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17575 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17576 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17577 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17578 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17579 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17580 solution is to fix the application.
17581
17582 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17583 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17584 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17585 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17586 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17587 external attacks.
17588
17589 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17590 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017591 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017592 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17593 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17594
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017595 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17596 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17597 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017598 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017599 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017600
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017601 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17602 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17603 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17604 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017605 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17606 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17607 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17608 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17609 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017610
17611 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17612 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17613 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17614 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17615
17616 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17617 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17618 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17619 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17620
17621 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17622 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17623 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17624 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17625
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017626The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17627persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17628important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17629re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17630
17631 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17632
17633 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17634 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17635 set on a GET request.
17636
17637 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17638 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017639 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017640 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17641
17642 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17643 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17644 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17645
17646 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17647 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17648 already got a cookie.
17649
17650 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17651 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17652 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17653 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17654 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17655
17656 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17657 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17658 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17659
17660 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17661 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17662 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17663
17664 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17665 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17666
17667 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17668 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17669 then advertised in the response.
17670
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176728.6. Non-printable characters
17673-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017674
17675In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17676consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17677converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17678prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17679being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17680escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17681is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17682'}' when logging headers.
17683
17684Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17685issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17686containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17687
17688Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17689the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17690performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17691
17692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176938.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17694---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017695
17696Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17697achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017698section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017699cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17700the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17701the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017702locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017703not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17704user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17705a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17706wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17707
17708 Examples :
17709 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17710 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17711
17712 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17713 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17714
17715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177168.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17717---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017718
17719Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17720proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17721the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17722server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17723
17724Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17725response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017726section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017727
17728It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017729time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17730appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017731are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17732and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17733follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17734request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17735in the logs.
17736
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017737As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17738frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17739an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17740
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017741 Example :
17742 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17743 listen proxy-out
17744 mode http
17745 option httplog
17746 option logasap
17747 log global
17748 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17749
17750 # log the name of the virtual server
17751 capture request header Host len 20
17752
17753 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17754 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17755
17756 # log the beginning of the referrer
17757 capture request header Referer len 20
17758
17759 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17760 capture response header Server len 20
17761
17762 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17763 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17764
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017765 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017766 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17767
17768 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17769 capture response header Via len 20
17770
17771 # log the URL location during a redirection
17772 capture response header Location len 20
17773
17774 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17775 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17776 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17777 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17778 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17779
17780 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17781 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17782 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17783 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017784 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017785
17786 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17787 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17788 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17789 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17790 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017791 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017792
17793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177948.9. Examples of logs
17795---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017796
17797These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17798them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17799reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17800
17801 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17802 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17803 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17804
17805 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17806 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17807
17808 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17809 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17810 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17811
17812 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17813 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17814
17815 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17816 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17817 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17818
17819 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017820 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017821 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17822 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17823
17824 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17825 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17826 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17827
17828 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17829 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017830 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017831 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17832 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17833 to return the 502 and not the server.
17834
17835 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017836 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017837
17838 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17839 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17840 Nothing was sent to any server.
17841
17842 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17843 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17844
17845 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17846 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017847 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017848 send a 408 return code to the client.
17849
17850 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17851 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17852
17853 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17854 5 seconds ("c----").
17855
17856 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17857 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017858 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017859
17860 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017861 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017862 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17863 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17864 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17865 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17866 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017867
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017868
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178699. Supported filters
17870--------------------
17871
17872Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17873accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17874unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17875
17876See also : "filter"
17877
178789.1. Trace
17879----------
17880
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017881filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017882
17883 Arguments:
17884 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17885 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17886
17887 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17888 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17889 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17890 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17891
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017892 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017893 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17894 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17895 amount of the parsed data.
17896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017897 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017898
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017899This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17900callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17901information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17902filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17903
17904Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17905tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17906a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17907
17908
179099.2. HTTP compression
17910---------------------
17911
17912filter compression
17913
17914The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17915keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017916when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17917it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17918response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17919line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17920cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17921the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017922
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017923See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017924
17925
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179269.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17927--------------------------------------------
17928
17929filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17930
17931 Arguments :
17932
17933 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17934 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17935 parsed.
17936
17937 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17938 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17939 part must be placed in its own scope.
17940
17941The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17942external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017943streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017944exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17945also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17946
17947SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17948the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17949
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017950For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017951"doc/SPOE.txt".
17952
17953Important note:
17954 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17955 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17956
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179579.4. Cache
17958----------
17959
17960filter cache <name>
17961
17962 Arguments :
17963
17964 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17965
17966The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17967"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17968cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017969other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17970the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17971mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17972filter other than the compression is used for the same
17973listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17974order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017975
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017976See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017977
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001797810. Cache
17979---------
17980
17981HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17982(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17983RAM.
17984
17985The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017986this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017987
17988If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17989independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17990when we try to allocate a new one.
17991
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017992The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017993
17994It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17995"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17996for more details.
17997
17998When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17999replaced by "<CACHE>".
18000
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001800110.1. Limitation
18002----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018003
18004The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18005
18006- If the response is not a 200
18007- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018008- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018009- If the response is not cacheable
18010
18011- If the request is not a GET
18012- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018013- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018014
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018015Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18016filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18017can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18018example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18019"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018020
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802110.2. Setup
18022-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018023
18024To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18025the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18026
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802710.2.1. Cache section
18028---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018029
18030cache <name>
18031 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18032 size of cache is mandatory.
18033
18034total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018035 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018036 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018037
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018038max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018039 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18040 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18041 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018042
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018043max-age <seconds>
18044 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18045 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18046 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18047 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18048 default.
18049
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001805010.2.2. Proxy section
18051---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018052
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018053http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018054 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18055 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18056 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18057 after this one.
18058
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018059http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018060 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18061 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18062 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18063 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18064
18065
18066Example:
18067
18068 backend bck1
18069 mode http
18070
18071 http-request cache-use foobar
18072 http-response cache-store foobar
18073 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18074
18075 cache foobar
18076 total-max-size 4
18077 max-age 240
18078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018079/*
18080 * Local variables:
18081 * fill-column: 79
18082 * End:
18083 */